blob: 1d69380c8a7ed09170f3d9829bff61d27822d945 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau2e077f82019-11-25 20:36:16 +01005 version 2.2
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaue54b43a2019-11-25 19:47:40 +01007 2019/11/25
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
574. Proxies
584.1. Proxy keywords matrix
594.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
60
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100615. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200625.1. Bind options
635.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200645.3. Server DNS resolution
655.3.1. Global overview
665.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020067
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100686. Cache
696.1. Limitation
706.2. Setup
716.2.1. Cache section
726.2.2. Proxy section
73
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200747. Using ACLs and fetching samples
757.1. ACL basics
767.1.1. Matching booleans
777.1.2. Matching integers
787.1.3. Matching strings
797.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
807.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
817.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
827.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
837.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200847.3.1. Converters
857.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
867.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
877.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
887.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
897.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +0100907.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200917.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092
938. Logging
948.1. Log levels
958.2. Log formats
968.2.1. Default log format
978.2.2. TCP log format
988.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100998.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001008.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001018.3. Advanced logging options
1028.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1038.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1048.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1058.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1068.4. Timing events
1078.5. Session state at disconnection
1088.6. Non-printable characters
1098.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1108.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1118.9. Examples of logs
112
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001139. Supported filters
1149.1. Trace
1159.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001169.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001179.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001189.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200119
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012010. FastCGI applications
12110.1. Setup
12210.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12310.1.2. Proxy section
12410.1.3. Example
12510.2. Default parameters
12610.3. Limitations
127
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128
1291. Quick reminder about HTTP
130----------------------------
131
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100132When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
134on almost anything found in the contents.
135
136However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
137formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
138correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
139
140
1411.1. The HTTP transaction model
142-------------------------------
143
144The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100145to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100146from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
147connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148will involve a new connection :
149
150 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
151
152In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
153establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
154by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
155length.
156
157Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
158to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
159however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
160response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
161header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
162
163 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
164
165Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
166power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
167but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200168a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100170Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
172second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
173page :
174
175 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
176
177This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
178latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
179correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
180the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100181server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100183The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
184time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
185are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
186parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
187carry the stream identifier.
188
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100189By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
190connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
191leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100192start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
193processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
194waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200195
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200196HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
198 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100199 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100200 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200201 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100202
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100203For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
204the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100205server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
206is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
207servers.
208
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209
2101.2. HTTP request
211-----------------
212
213First, let's consider this HTTP request :
214
215 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100216 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200217 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
218 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
219 3 User-agent: my small browser
220 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
221 5 Accept: image/png
222
223
2241.2.1. The Request line
225-----------------------
226
227Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
228
229 - a METHOD : GET
230 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
231 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
232
233All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
234which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
235followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
236is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
237desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
238the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
239
240The URI itself can have several forms :
241
242 - A "relative URI" :
243
244 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
245
246 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
247 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
248
249 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
250
251 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
252
253 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
254 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
255 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
256 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
257 must accept this form too.
258
259 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
260 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
261 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100262
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200263 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
264 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
265 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
266 other protocols too.
267
268In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
269mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
270on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
271It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
272specific to the language, framework or application in use.
273
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100274HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100275assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100276However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
277received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
278processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
279as well as in server logs.
280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200281
2821.2.2. The request headers
283--------------------------
284
285The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
286beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
287an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
288Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
289values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
290encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
291the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
292define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
293
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100294Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200295their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100296"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
297as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200298
299The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
300that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
301is one valid form of empty line.
302
303Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
304headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
305about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
306application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
307
308Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000309 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200310 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
311 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
312 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
313
314
3151.3. HTTP response
316------------------
317
318An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
319messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
320
321 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100322 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200323 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
324 2 Content-length: 350
325 3 Content-Type: text/html
326
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200327As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
328codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
329response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100330continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
331the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
332following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
333sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
334(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
335correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
336such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
337state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
338over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
339if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
340information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200341
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200342
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003431.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344------------------------
345
346Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
347
348 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
349 - a status code : 200
350 - a reason : OK
351
352The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100353 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
354 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
355 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
356 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
357 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200358
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000359Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100360"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
362messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
363or "Authentication Required".
364
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100365HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200366
367 Code When / reason
368 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
369 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
370 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100372 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200374 400 for an invalid or too large request
375 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
376 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200377 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100378 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200379 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100380 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
381 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
383 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
384 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200385 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200386 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
387 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
388 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
389
390The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3914.2).
392
393
3941.3.2. The response headers
395---------------------------
396
397Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
398the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
399details.
400
401
4022. Configuring HAProxy
403----------------------
404
4052.1. Configuration file format
406------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200407
408HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
409
410 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
411 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
412 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
413 "frontend" and "backend".
414
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100415The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
416referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200417delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100418
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200419
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004202.2. Quoting and escaping
421-------------------------
422
423HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
424many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
425with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
426single quotes.
427
428If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
429them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
430escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
431
432Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
433
434 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
435 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
436 \\ to use a backslash
437 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
438 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
439
440Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
441the interpretation of:
442
443 space as a parameter separator
444 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
445 # hash as a comment start
446
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200447Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
448-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
449backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
450
451Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200452quoting.
453
454Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
455nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
456
457Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
458equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
459
460 Example:
461 # those are equivalents:
462 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
463 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
464 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
465 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
466 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
467
468 # those are equivalents:
469 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
470 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
471 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
472 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
473
474
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004752.3. Environment variables
476--------------------------
477
478HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
479interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
480configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
481optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
482shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
483underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
484
485 Example:
486
487 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
488
489 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
490
491 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
492
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200493Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
494file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200495
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200496* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
497 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
498
499* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
500 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
501 directory.
502
503* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
504
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500505* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200506 processes, separated by semicolons.
507
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500508* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200509 CLI, separated by semicolons.
510
511See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200512
5132.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200514----------------
515
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100516Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100517values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
518otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
519numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
520for every keyword. Supported units are :
521
522 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
523 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
524 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
525 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
526 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
527 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
528
529
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005302.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200531-------------
532
533 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
534 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
535 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
536 global
537 daemon
538 maxconn 256
539
540 defaults
541 mode http
542 timeout connect 5000ms
543 timeout client 50000ms
544 timeout server 50000ms
545
546 frontend http-in
547 bind *:80
548 default_backend servers
549
550 backend servers
551 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
552
553
554 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
555 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
556 global
557 daemon
558 maxconn 256
559
560 defaults
561 mode http
562 timeout connect 5000ms
563 timeout client 50000ms
564 timeout server 50000ms
565
566 listen http-in
567 bind *:80
568 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
569
570
571Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
572
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100573 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200574
575
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005763. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577--------------------
578
579Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
580are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
581of them have command-line equivalents.
582
583The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
584
585 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200586 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200587 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200588 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200589 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200590 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200591 - description
592 - deviceatlas-json-file
593 - deviceatlas-log-level
594 - deviceatlas-separator
595 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900596 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597 - gid
598 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100599 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200600 - h1-case-adjust
601 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100602 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100603 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200604 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200605 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100606 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200607 - lua-load
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200608 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200609 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200610 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200611 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200612 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100613 - presetenv
614 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200615 - uid
616 - ulimit-n
617 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200618 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100619 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200620 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200621 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200622 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200623 - ssl-default-bind-options
624 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200625 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200626 - ssl-default-server-options
627 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100628 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100629 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100630 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100631 - 51degrees-data-file
632 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200633 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200634 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200635 - wurfl-data-file
636 - wurfl-information-list
637 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200638 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100639 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100640
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200641 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100642 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200643 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200644 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200645 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100646 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100647 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100648 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200649 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200650 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200651 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200652 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200653 - noepoll
654 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000655 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200656 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100657 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300658 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000659 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100660 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200661 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200662 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200663 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000664 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000665 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200666 - tune.buffers.limit
667 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200668 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200669 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100670 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200671 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200672 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200673 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100674 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200675 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200676 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100677 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100678 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100679 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100680 - tune.lua.session-timeout
681 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200682 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100683 - tune.maxaccept
684 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200685 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200686 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200687 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100688 - tune.rcvbuf.client
689 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100690 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200691 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100692 - tune.sndbuf.client
693 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100694 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100695 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200696 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100697 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200698 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200699 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100700 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200701 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100702 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200703 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
704 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
705 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100706 - tune.zlib.memlevel
707 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100708
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200709 * Debugging
710 - debug
711 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200712
713
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007143.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200715------------------------------------
716
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200717ca-base <dir>
718 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200719 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
720 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200721
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200722chroot <jail dir>
723 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
724 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
725 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
726 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
727 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100728 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100729
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100730cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
731 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
732 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
733 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
734 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
735 set. These sets have the format
736
737 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
738
739 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100740 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100741 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
742 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100743 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
744 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100745 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100746 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100747 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100748 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100749 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
750 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
751 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
752 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100753
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100754 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
755 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
756 on the machine's word size.
757
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100758 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100759 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
760 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
761 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
762 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
763 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
764 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100765
766 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100767 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
768
769 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
770 # first 4 CPUs
771
772 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
773 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
774 # word size.
775
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100776 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100777 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100778 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
779 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
780 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
781
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100782 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
783 # and so on.
784 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
785 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
786 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
787
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100788 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100789 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
790 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
791 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
792
793 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
794 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
795 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
796
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100797 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
798 # and a thread range.
799 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
800 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
801 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
802
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200803crt-base <dir>
804 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100805 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
806 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200807
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200808daemon
809 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
810 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100811 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
812 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200813
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200814deviceatlas-json-file <path>
815 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100816 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200817
818deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100819 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200820 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
821
822deviceatlas-separator <char>
823 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
824 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
825
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100826deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200827 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
828 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
829 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100830
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900831external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100832 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
833 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100834 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
835 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
836 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
837 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
838 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900839
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200840gid <number>
841 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
842 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
843 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100844 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
845 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200846 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100847
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100848group <group name>
849 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
850 See also "gid" and "user".
851
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100852hard-stop-after <time>
853 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
854
855 Arguments :
856 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
857 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
858 SIGUSR1 signal.
859
860 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
861 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
862 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
863
864 Example:
865 global
866 hard-stop-after 30s
867
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200868h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
869 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
870 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
871 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
872 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
873 ajusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
874 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
875 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
876 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
877 specified in a proxy.
878
879 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
880 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
881 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
882 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
883 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
884 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
885 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
886
887 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
888 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
889 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
890 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
891 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
892
893 Example:
894 global
895 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
896
897 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
898 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
899
900h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
901 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
902 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
903 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
904 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
905 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
906 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
907 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
908 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
909
910 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
911 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
912 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
913
914 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
915 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
916
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100917insecure-fork-wanted
918 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
919 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
920 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
921 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
922 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
923 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
924 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
925 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
926 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
927 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
928 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
929 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
930 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
931 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
932 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
933 disable it.
934
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100935insecure-setuid-wanted
936 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
937 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
938 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
939 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
940 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
941 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
942 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
943 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
944 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
945 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
946 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
947 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
948 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
949 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
950
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200951log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
952 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100953 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100954 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100955 configured with "log global".
956
957 <address> can be one of:
958
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100959 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100960 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
961 port).
962
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100963 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
964 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
965 port).
966
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100967 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100968 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
969 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100970 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100971
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100972 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
973 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
974 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
975 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
976 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
977 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
978 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
979 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
980 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
981 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
982 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
983 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
984 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
985 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100986 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
987 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100988
989 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
990 "fd@2", see above.
991
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +0200992 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
993 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
994 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
995 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
996 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
997
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200998 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
999 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001000
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001001 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1002 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1003 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1004 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1005 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1006 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1007 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1008 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1009 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1010 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001011 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1012 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001013
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001014 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1015 one of the following :
1016
1017 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1018 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1019
1020 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1021 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1022
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001023 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1024 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1025 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1026 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1027 logger consumes.
1028
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001029 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1030 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1031 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1032 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1033
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001034 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1035 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1036 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1037 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1038 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1039
1040 <sample_size>
1041 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1042 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1043 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1044 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1045 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1046
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001047 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001048
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001049 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1050 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1051 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1052
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001053 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1054 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1055 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1056 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001057
1058 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001059 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1060 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1061 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1062 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1063 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1064 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001065
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001066 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001067
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001068log-send-hostname [<string>]
1069 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1070 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1071 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1072 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1073 the logs.
1074
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001075log-tag <string>
1076 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1077 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1078 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001079 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001080
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001081lua-load <file>
1082 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1083 used multiple times.
1084
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001085master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001086 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1087 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1088 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001089 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001090 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1091 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001092 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1093 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1094 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1095 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1096 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001097
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001098 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001099
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001100mworker-max-reloads <number>
1101 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001102 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001103 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1104 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1105 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1106
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001107nbproc <number>
1108 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1109 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1110 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001111 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1112 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001113 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1114 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001115
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001116nbthread <number>
1117 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001118 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1119 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1120 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1121 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1122 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001123 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1124 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1125 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1126 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1127 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1128 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1129 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001130
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001131pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001132 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001133 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1134 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1135
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001136presetenv <name> <value>
1137 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1138 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1139 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1140 and "unsetenv".
1141
1142resetenv [<name> ...]
1143 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1144 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1145 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1146 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1147 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1148 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1149 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1150 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1151
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001152stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001153 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1154 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1155 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1156 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1157 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1158 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001159 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001160 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1161 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1162 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1163 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001164
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001165server-state-base <directory>
1166 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001167 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1168 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001169
1170server-state-file <file>
1171 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1172 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1173 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1174 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1175 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1176 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1177 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1178 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001179 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1180 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001181
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001182setenv <name> <value>
1183 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1184 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1185 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1186 and "unsetenv".
1187
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001188set-dumpable
1189 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001190 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1191 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1192 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1193 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1194 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1195 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1196 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1197 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1198 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1199 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1200 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1201 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1202 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1203 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1204 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1205 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1206 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001207
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001208ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1209 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1210 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001211 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001212 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001213 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1214 information and recommendations see e.g.
1215 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1216 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1217 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1218 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001219
1220ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1221 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1222 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1223 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1224 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1225 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001226 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1227 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1228 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001229 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001230
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001231ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1232 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1233 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1234 keyword to see available options.
1235
1236 Example:
1237 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001238 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001239
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001240ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1241 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1242 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001243 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001244 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001245 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1246 information and recommendations see e.g.
1247 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1248 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1249 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1250 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1251 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001252
1253ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1254 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1255 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1256 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1257 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1258 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001259 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1260 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1261 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1262 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001263
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001264ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1265 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1266 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1267 keyword to see available options.
1268
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001269ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1270 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1271 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1272 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001273 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001274 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001275 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1276 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1277 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1278 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001279 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1280 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1281 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1282
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001283ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1284 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1285 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1286 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1287
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001288stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1289 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1290 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1291 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001292 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001293 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001294
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001295 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1296 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1297 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001298
1299stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1300 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1301 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001302 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001303
1304stats maxconn <connections>
1305 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1306 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1307
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001308uid <number>
1309 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1310 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1311 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1312 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1313
1314ulimit-n <number>
1315 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1316 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1317 option.
1318
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001319unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1320 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1321
1322 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1323 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1324 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1325 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1326 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1327 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1328 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1329 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1330 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1331 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1332
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001333unsetenv [<name> ...]
1334 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1335 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1336 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1337 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1338 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1339 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1340 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1341
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001342user <user name>
1343 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1344 See also "uid" and "group".
1345
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001346node <name>
1347 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1348
1349 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1350 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1351 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1352 traffic.
1353
1354description <text>
1355 Add a text that describes the instance.
1356
1357 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1358 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1359 "<" and ">" characters.
1360
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100136151degrees-data-file <file path>
1362 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001363 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001364
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001365 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001366 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1367
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000136851degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001369 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1370 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1371 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1372
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001373 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001374 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1375
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200137651degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001377 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1378 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1379
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001380 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1381 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1382
138351degrees-cache-size <number>
1384 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1385 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1386 By default, this cache is disabled.
1387
1388 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001389 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1390
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001391wurfl-data-file <file path>
1392 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1393 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1394
1395 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1396 with USE_WURFL=1.
1397
1398wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1399 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1400 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1401 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1402
1403 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1404
1405 Valid WURFL properties are:
1406 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1407
1408 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1409 device.
1410
1411 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1412 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1413
1414 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1415 particular web request.
1416
1417 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1418 used Libwurfl API version.
1419
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001420 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1421 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1422
1423 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1424 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1425
1426 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1427
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001428 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1429 with USE_WURFL=1.
1430
1431wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1432 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1433 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1434
1435 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1436 with USE_WURFL=1.
1437
1438wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1439 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1440 thus before the chroot.
1441
1442 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1443 with USE_WURFL=1.
1444
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001445wurfl-cache-size <size>
1446 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1447 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001448 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001449 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001450
1451 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1452 with USE_WURFL=1.
1453
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001454strict-limits
1455 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy is tries to set
1456 the best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it
1457 will emit a warning. Use this option if you want an explicit failure of
1458 haproxy when those limits fail. This option is disabled by default. If it has
1459 been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no"
1460 keyword.
1461
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014623.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001463-----------------------
1464
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001465busy-polling
1466 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1467 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1468 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1469 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1470 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1471 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1472 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1473 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1474 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1475 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1476 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1477 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1478 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1479 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1480 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1481 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1482 "poll" pollers.
1483
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001484 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1485 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1486 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1487
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001488max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1489 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1490 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1491 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1492 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1493 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1494 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1495 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1496 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1497
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001498maxconn <number>
1499 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1500 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1501 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001502 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1503 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1504 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1505 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001506 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1507 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1508 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1509 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1510 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1511 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001512
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001513maxconnrate <number>
1514 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1515 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1516 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1517 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1518 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1519 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1520 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1521 fairness.
1522
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001523maxcomprate <number>
1524 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001525 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001526 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1527 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1528 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001529 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001530 default value.
1531
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001532maxcompcpuusage <number>
1533 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1534 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1535 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1536 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1537 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1538 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1539 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1540 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1541
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001542maxpipes <number>
1543 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1544 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1545 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1546 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1547 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1548 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1549
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001550maxsessrate <number>
1551 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1552 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1553 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1554 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1555 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1556 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1557 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1558 fairness.
1559
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001560maxsslconn <number>
1561 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1562 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1563 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1564 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1565 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1566 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1567 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001568 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1569 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1570 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1571 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1572 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1573 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1574 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001575
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001576maxsslrate <number>
1577 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1578 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1579 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1580 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1581 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1582 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1583 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1584 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1585 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1586 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1587
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001588maxzlibmem <number>
1589 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1590 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1591 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001592 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1593 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1594 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1595
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001596noepoll
1597 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1598 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001599 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001600
1601nokqueue
1602 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1603 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1604 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1605
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001606noevports
1607 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1608 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1609 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1610 also "nopoll".
1611
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001612nopoll
1613 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1614 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001615 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001616 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1617 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001618
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001619nosplice
1620 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001621 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001622 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001623 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001624 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1625 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1626 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1627 "option splice-response".
1628
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001629nogetaddrinfo
1630 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1631 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1632
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001633noreuseport
1634 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1635 command line argument "-dR".
1636
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001637profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1638 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1639 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1640 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1641 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001642 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001643 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1644 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1645 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1646 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1647
1648 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1649 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1650 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1651 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1652 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001653 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1654 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1655 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1656 CLI.
1657
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001658spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001659 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1660 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1661 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1662 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1663 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1664 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001665
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001666ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001667 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001668 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001669 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1670 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1671 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1672 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1673 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001674 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1675 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001676 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1677 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1678 openssl configuration file uses:
1679 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1680
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001681ssl-mode-async
1682 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001683 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001684 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1685 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1686 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001687 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001688 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001689
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001690tune.buffers.limit <number>
1691 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1692 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1693 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1694 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1695 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001696 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001697 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1698 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1699 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1700 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1701 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1702 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1703 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1704 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1705 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1706
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001707tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1708 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1709 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1710 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1711 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1712
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001713tune.bufsize <number>
1714 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1715 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1716 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1717 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1718 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1719 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1720 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001721 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1722 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1723 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001724 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001725 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1726 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1727 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001728
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001729tune.chksize <number>
1730 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1731 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1732 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1733 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1734 checks whenever possible.
1735
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001736tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1737 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1738 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1739 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1740 this value. The default value is 1.
1741
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001742tune.fail-alloc
1743 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1744 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1745 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1746 gracefully.
1747
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001748tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1749 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1750 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1751 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1752 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1753 change it.
1754
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001755tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1756 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001757 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1758 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001759 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1760 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1761 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1762 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1763 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1764
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001765tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1766 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1767 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1768 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1769 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1770 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1771 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1772 recommended not to change this value.
1773
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001774tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1775 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1776 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1777 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1778 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1779 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1780 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1781 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1782
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001783tune.http.cookielen <number>
1784 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1785 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1786 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1787 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1788 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1789 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1790 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1791 to change this value.
1792
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001793tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001794 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1795 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001796 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001797 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001798 configuration directives too.
1799 The default value is 1024.
1800
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001801tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1802 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1803 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1804 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1805 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1806 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1807 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001808 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1809 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1810 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001811
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001812tune.idletimer <timeout>
1813 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1814 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1815 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1816 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1817 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1818 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001819 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001820 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001821 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1822
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001823tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1824 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1825 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1826 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1827 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1828 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1829 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1830 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1831 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1832 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1833
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001834tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1835 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001836 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001837 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1838 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001839 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001840 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1841 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1842
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001843tune.lua.maxmem
1844 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1845 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1846 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1847 memory.
1848
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001849tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1850 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001851 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1852 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001853 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001854
1855tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1856 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1857 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1858 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1859 check servers.
1860
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001861tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1862 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1863 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1864 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001865 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001866
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001867tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001868 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1869 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1870 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1871 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1872 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1873 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1874 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1875 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1876 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1877 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001878
1879tune.maxpollevents <number>
1880 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1881 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1882 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1883 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1884 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1885
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001886tune.maxrewrite <number>
1887 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1888 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1889 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1890 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1891 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1892 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1893 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1894 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1895 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1896 bufsize.
1897
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001898tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1899 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1900 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1901 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1902 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1903 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1904 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1905 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1906 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1907 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02001908 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
1909 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001910 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1911 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1912 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1913 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1914 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1915 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1916 setting this parameter to 0.
1917
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001918tune.pipesize <number>
1919 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1920 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1921 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1922 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1923 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1924 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1925
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001926tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1927 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1928 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1929 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1930 default is 20.
1931
1932tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1933 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1934 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1935 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1936 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1937 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1938 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001939 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001940
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001941tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1942tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1943 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1944 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1945 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001946 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001947 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001948 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1949 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1950
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001951tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001952 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001953 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1954 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1955 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1956 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1957
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001958tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001959 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001960 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1961 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1962
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001963tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1964tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1965 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1966 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1967 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001968 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001969 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001970 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1971 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1972 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1973 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1974 notifying haproxy again.
1975
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001976tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001977 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1978 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1979 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001980 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001981 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001982 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001983 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1984 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1985 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001986 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1987 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001988
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001989tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001990 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001991 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1992 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1993 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1994 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1995 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1996
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001997tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1998 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001999 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002000 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2001 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2002 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2003 being used for too long.
2004
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002005tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2006 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2007 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2008 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2009 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2010 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2011 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2012 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2013 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2014 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2015 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002016 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002017 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002018
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002019tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2020 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2021 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2022 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2023 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
2024 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
2025 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2026 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002027 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2028 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002029
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002030tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2031 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2032 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2033 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2034 1000 entries.
2035
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002036tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2037 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2038 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2039 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2040
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002041tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002042tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002043tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2044tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2045tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002046 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2047 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2048 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2049 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2050 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2051 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2052 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2053 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002054
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002055 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2056 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2057 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2058 all available space is consumed.
2059 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2060 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2061 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002062
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002063tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2064 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002065 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002066 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002067 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002068 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2069
2070tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2071 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2072 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002073 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2074 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002075
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020763.3. Debugging
2077--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002078
2079debug
2080 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2081 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2082 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2083 system startup.
2084
2085quiet
2086 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2087 line argument "-q".
2088
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002089
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020903.4. Userlists
2091--------------
2092It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2093http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2094it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2095
2096userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002097 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002098 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2099
2100group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002101 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002102 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2103 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2104
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002105user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2106 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002107 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2108 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002109 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2110 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2111 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2112 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002113
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002114 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2115 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2116 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2117 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2118 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2119 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2120 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2121 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2122 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002123
2124 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002125 userlist L1
2126 group G1 users tiger,scott
2127 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002128
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002129 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2130 user scott insecure-password elgato
2131 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002132
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002133 userlist L2
2134 group G1
2135 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002136
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002137 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2138 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2139 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002140
2141 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002142
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002143
21443.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002145----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002146It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2147several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2148instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2149values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2150automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2151In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2152using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2153tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2154reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2155Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2156that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2157each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002158
2159peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002160 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002161 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2162
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002163bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2164 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2165 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2166
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002167disabled
2168 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2169 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2170 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2171
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002172default-bind [param*]
2173 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2174
2175default-server [param*]
2176 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2177
2178 Arguments:
2179 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2180 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2181 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2182 details.
2183
2184
2185 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2186
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002187enable
2188 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2189
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002190log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2191 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2192 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2193 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2194 more details.
2195
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002196peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002197 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2198 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2199 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2200 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2201 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2202 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2203
2204 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2205 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2206
2207 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2208 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2209 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2210 across all peers.
2211
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002212 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2213 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002214
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002215 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2216 "server" keyword explanation below).
2217
2218server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002219 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002220 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2221 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2222 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2223 of this "peers" section).
2224 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2225
2226
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002227 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002228 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002229 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002230 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2231 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2232 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002233
2234 backend mybackend
2235 mode tcp
2236 balance roundrobin
2237 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2238 stick on src
2239
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002240 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2241 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002242
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002243 Example:
2244 peers mypeers
2245 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2246 default-server ssl verify none
2247 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2248 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002249
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002250
2251table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2252 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2253
2254 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2255 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002256 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002257 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2258 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2259 "stick-table" keyword).
2260
2261 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2262 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2263 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2264 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2265 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2266 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2267 of the stick-table name as follows:
2268
2269 peers mypeers
2270 peer A ...
2271 peer B ...
2272 table t1 ...
2273
2274 frontend fe1
2275 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2276
2277 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2278 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2279
2280 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2281 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2282 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2283 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2284 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2285 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2286 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2287
2288 peers mypeers
2289 peer A ...
2290 peer B ...
2291 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2292
2293 backend t1
2294 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2295
2296 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2297 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2298 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2299
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090023003.6. Mailers
2301------------
2302It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2303If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2304in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2305
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002306mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002307 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2308 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2309
2310mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2311 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2312
2313 Example:
2314 mailers mymailers
2315 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2316 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2317
2318 backend mybackend
2319 mode tcp
2320 balance roundrobin
2321
2322 email-alert mailers mymailers
2323 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2324 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2325
2326 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2327 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2328
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002329timeout mail <time>
2330 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2331 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2332 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2333 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2334
2335 Example:
2336 mailers mymailers
2337 timeout mail 20s
2338 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002339
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020023403.7. Programs
2341-------------
2342In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2343master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2344managed the same way as the workers.
2345
2346During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2347sequence as a worker:
2348
2349 - the master is re-executed
2350 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2351 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2352 instance of the program
2353
2354During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2355
2356program <name>
2357 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2358 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2359 the management guide).
2360
2361command <command> [arguments*]
2362 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2363 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2364 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2365 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2366
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002367user <user name>
2368 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2369 See also "group".
2370
2371group <group name>
2372 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2373 See also "user".
2374
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002375option start-on-reload
2376no option start-on-reload
2377 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2378 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2379 program section.
2380
2381
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010023823.8. HTTP-errors
2383----------------
2384
2385It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2386imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2387several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2388
2389http-errors <name>
2390 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2391 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2392
2393errorfile <code> <file>
2394 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2395
2396 Arguments :
2397 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2398 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429,
2399 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2400
2401 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2402 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2403 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2404 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2405 before any chroot is performed.
2406
2407 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2408
2409 Example:
2410 http-errors website-1
2411 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2412 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2413 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2414
2415 http-errors website-2
2416 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2417 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2418 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2419
2420
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024214. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002422----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002423
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002424Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002425 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002426 - frontend <name>
2427 - backend <name>
2428 - listen <name>
2429
2430A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2431its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2432section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002433section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002434
2435A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2436connections.
2437
2438A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2439to forward incoming connections.
2440
2441A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2442parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2443
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002444All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2445'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2446case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2447
2448Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2449logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2450proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2451However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2452name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2453
2454Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2455and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002456bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002457protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2458modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2459arbitrary criteria.
2460
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002461In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2462a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002463the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002464
2465 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2466 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2467 between responses and new requests.
2468
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002469 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2470 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2471 client-facing connection remains open.
2472
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002473 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2474 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002475
2476The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2477frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2478following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002479weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002480
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002481 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002482
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002483 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2484 ----+-----+-----+----
2485 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2486 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002487 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2488 ----+-----+-----+----
2489 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002490
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002491
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002492
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024934.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2494--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002495
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002496The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2497limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2498they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2499limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002500marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002501option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002502and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2503with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2504specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002505
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002506
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002507 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2508------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2509acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002510backlog X X X -
2511balance X - X X
2512bind - X X -
2513bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002514capture cookie - X X -
2515capture request header - X X -
2516capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002517compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002518cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002519declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002520default-server X - X X
2521default_backend X X X -
2522description - X X X
2523disabled X X X X
2524dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002525email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002526email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002527email-alert mailers X X X X
2528email-alert myhostname X X X X
2529email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002530enabled X X X X
2531errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002532errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002533errorloc X X X X
2534errorloc302 X X X X
2535-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2536errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002537force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002538filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002539fullconn X - X X
2540grace X X X X
2541hash-type X - X X
2542http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002543http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002544http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002545http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002546http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002547http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002548http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002549id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002550ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002551load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002552log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002553log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002554log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002555log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002556max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002557maxconn X X X -
2558mode X X X X
2559monitor fail - X X -
2560monitor-net X X X -
2561monitor-uri X X X -
2562option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2563option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2564option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2565option allbackups (*) X - X X
2566option checkcache (*) X - X X
2567option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2568option contstats (*) X X X -
2569option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2570option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002571-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2572option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002573option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2574option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002575option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002576option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002577option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002578option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002579option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002580option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2581option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2582option httpchk X - X X
2583option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002584option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002585option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002586option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002587option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002588option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002589option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2590option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2591option logasap (*) X X X -
2592option mysql-check X - X X
2593option nolinger (*) X X X X
2594option originalto X X X X
2595option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002596option pgsql-check X - X X
2597option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002598option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002599option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002600option smtpchk X - X X
2601option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2602option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2603option splice-request (*) X X X X
2604option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002605option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002606option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2607option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2608-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002609option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002610option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2611option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2612option tcpka X X X X
2613option tcplog X X X X
2614option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002615external-check command X - X X
2616external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002617persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2618rate-limit sessions X X X -
2619redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002620-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002621retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002622retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002623server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002624server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002625server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002626source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002627stats admin - X X X
2628stats auth X X X X
2629stats enable X X X X
2630stats hide-version X X X X
2631stats http-request - X X X
2632stats realm X X X X
2633stats refresh X X X X
2634stats scope X X X X
2635stats show-desc X X X X
2636stats show-legends X X X X
2637stats show-node X X X X
2638stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002639-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2640stick match - - X X
2641stick on - - X X
2642stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002643stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002644stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002645tcp-check connect - - X X
2646tcp-check expect - - X X
2647tcp-check send - - X X
2648tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002649tcp-request connection - X X -
2650tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002651tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002652tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002653tcp-response content - - X X
2654tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002655timeout check X - X X
2656timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002657timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002658timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002659timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2660timeout http-request X X X X
2661timeout queue X - X X
2662timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002663timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002664timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002665timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002666transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002667unique-id-format X X X -
2668unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002669use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002670use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002671use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002672------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2673 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002674
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002675
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026764.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2677---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002678
2679This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2680
2681
2682acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2683 Declare or complete an access list.
2684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2685 no | yes | yes | yes
2686 Example:
2687 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2688 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2689 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2690
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002691 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002692
2693
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002694backlog <conns>
2695 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2697 yes | yes | yes | no
2698 Arguments :
2699 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2700 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002701 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002702
2703 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2704 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2705 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2706 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2707 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2708 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2709 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2710 backlog parameter.
2711
2712 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2713 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2714 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2715
2716 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2717
2718
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002719balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002720balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002721 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2723 yes | no | yes | yes
2724 Arguments :
2725 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2726 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2727 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2728 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2729
2730 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2731 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2732 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2733 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002734 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002735 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002736 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2737 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2738 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2739 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2740 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2741 it, so that you don't worry.
2742
2743 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2744 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2745 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2746 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2747 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2748 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2749 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2750 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002751
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002752 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2753 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2754 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2755 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2756 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2757 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2758 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2759 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2760
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002761 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002762 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002763 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2764 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002765 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002766 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2767 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2768 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2769 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2770 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002771 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2772 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2773 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2774 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2775 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2776 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002777
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002778 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2779 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2780 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2781 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2782 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2783 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2784 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2785 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002786 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002787 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002788 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2789 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2790 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002791
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002792 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2793 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2794 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2795 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2796 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2797 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2798 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2799 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2800 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2801 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2802 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2803 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002804
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002805 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002806 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2807 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2808 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2809 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2810 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2811 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2812 URIs start with a leading "/".
2813
2814 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2815 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2816 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2817 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2818
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002819 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002820 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2821
2822 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002823 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2824 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002825 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2826 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2827 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2828 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002829 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002830 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2831 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002832
2833 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2834 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2835 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2836 server will receive the request.
2837
2838 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2839 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2840 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2841 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2842 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002843 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2844 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2845 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002846
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002847 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2848 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2849 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2850 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2851 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002852
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002853 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002854 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2855 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2856 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2857
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002858 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2859 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2860 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2861
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002862 random
2863 random(<draws>)
2864 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002865 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2866 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2867 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2868 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002869 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2870 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2871 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2872 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2873 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2874 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2875 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2876 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2877 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2878 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2879 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2880 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2881 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2882 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2883 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2884 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2885 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2886 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2887 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2888 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002889
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002890 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002891 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002892 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2893 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2894 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2895 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2896 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2897 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002898 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002899 used instead.
2900
2901 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2902 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2903 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2904 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2905
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002906 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2907 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2908 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2909
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002910 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002911
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002912 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002913 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2914 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002915
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002916 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2917 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2918 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002919
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002920 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002921 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002922 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2923 NTLM relies on.
2924
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002925 Examples :
2926 balance roundrobin
2927 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002928 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002929 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2930 balance hdr(host)
2931 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002932
2933 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2934 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2935
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002936 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002937 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2938 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2939 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02002940 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002941
2942 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2943 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2944 defaults to 16 kB.
2945
2946 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2947 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2948
2949 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2950 Round Robin.
2951
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002952 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002953 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2954 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2955 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2956
2957 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2958
2959 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002960 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002961 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2962 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2963 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002964
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002965 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002966
2967
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002968bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2969bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002970 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2972 no | yes | yes | no
2973 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002974 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2975 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2976 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2977 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002978 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002979 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2980 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2981 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2982 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2983 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2984 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2985 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002986 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2987 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2988 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2989 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2990 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2991 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2992 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002993 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2994 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2995 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002996 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2997 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2998 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2999 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003000 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3001 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3002 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003003
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003004 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3005 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003006 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3007 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3008 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003009 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3010 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3011 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3012 the range.
3013
3014 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3015 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3016 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3017 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3018 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3019 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3020 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003021 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003022 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003023
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003024 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003025 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003026 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3027 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3028 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3029 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3030 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3031 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3032
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003033 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3034 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3035 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3036 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003037
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003038 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3039 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3040 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3041 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3042 in a frontend.
3043
3044 Example :
3045 listen http_proxy
3046 bind :80,:443
3047 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003048 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003049
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003050 listen http_https_proxy
3051 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003052 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003053
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003054 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3055 bind ipv6@:80
3056 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3057 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3058
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003059 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003060 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003061
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003062 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3063 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3064 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3065 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3066 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3067
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003068 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003069 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003070
3071
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003072bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003073 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3075 yes | yes | yes | yes
3076 Arguments :
3077 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3078 may be used to override a default value.
3079
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003080 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003081 option may be combined with other numbers.
3082
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003083 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003084 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3085 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3086 missing from all processes.
3087
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003088 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003089 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003090 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3091 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3092 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3093 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3094 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003095 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003096
3097 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3098 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3099 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3100 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3101 and 'even' instances.
3102
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003103 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3104 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3105 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3106 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003107
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003108 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3109 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3110
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003111 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3112 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3113 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3114
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003115 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3116 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3117
3118 Example :
3119 listen app_ip1
3120 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003121 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003122
3123 listen app_ip2
3124 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003125 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003126
3127 listen management
3128 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003129 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003130
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003131 listen management
3132 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3133 bind-process 1-4
3134
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003135 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003136
3137
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003138capture cookie <name> len <length>
3139 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3141 no | yes | yes | no
3142 Arguments :
3143 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3144 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3145 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3146 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003147 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003148
3149 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3150 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3151 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3152 right if it exceeds <length>.
3153
3154 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3155 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3156 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3157 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3158
3159 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3160 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3161 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3162
3163 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3164 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3165 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003166 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3167 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3168 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003169
3170 Example:
3171 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3172
3173 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003174 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003175
3176
3177capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003178 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3180 no | yes | yes | no
3181 Arguments :
3182 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003183 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003184 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3185 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3186 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3187
3188 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3189 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3190 it exceeds <length>.
3191
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003192 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003193 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3194 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003195 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3196 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3197 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3198 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003199 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003200 environments to find where the request came from.
3201
3202 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3203 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3204 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3205 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003206
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003207 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3208 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3209 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3210 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3211 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003212
3213 Example:
3214 capture request header Host len 15
3215 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003216 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003217
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003218 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003219 about logging.
3220
3221
3222capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003223 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3225 no | yes | yes | no
3226 Arguments :
3227 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003228 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003229 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3230 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3231 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3232
3233 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3234 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3235 it exceeds <length>.
3236
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003237 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003238 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3239 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3240 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003241 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3242 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3243 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3244 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003245
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003246 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3247 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3248 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3249 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3250 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003251
3252 Example:
3253 capture response header Content-length len 9
3254 capture response header Location len 15
3255
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003256 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003257 about logging.
3258
3259
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003260compression algo <algorithm> ...
3261compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003262compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003263 Enable HTTP compression.
3264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3265 yes | yes | yes | yes
3266 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003267 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3268 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3269 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3270
3271 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003272 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3273 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3274 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003275
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003276 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003277 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003278
3279 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3280 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3281 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3282 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3283 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003284 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003285
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003286 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3287 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3288 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3289 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3290 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3291 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3292 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003293 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003294
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003295 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003296 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003297 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3298 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3299 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3300 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3301 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003302
3303 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3304 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3305 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3306 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3307 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003308 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3309 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3310 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3311 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3312 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003313 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3314 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003315
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003316 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003317 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3318 "Accept-Encoding" header
3319 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003320 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003321 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3322 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3323 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3324 "multipart"
3325 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3326 header
3327 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3328 and later
3329 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3330 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003331 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003332
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003333 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003334
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003335 Examples :
3336 compression algo gzip
3337 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003338
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003339
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003340cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003341 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3342 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003343 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003344 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3346 yes | no | yes | yes
3347 Arguments :
3348 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3349 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3350 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3351 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3352 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3353 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003354 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003355 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3356 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3357
3358 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3359 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3360 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3361 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3362 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3363 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003364 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3365 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003366 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003367 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3368 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003369
3370 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003371 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003372
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003373 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003374 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003375 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003376 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003377 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3378 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3379 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3380 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3381 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3382 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3383 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003384
3385 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3386 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3387 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3388 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3389 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3390 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3391 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3392 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3393 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003394 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003395 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3396 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3397 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003398
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003399 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3400 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3401 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003402 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3403 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3404 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3405 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003406 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3407 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3408 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003409
3410 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3411 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3412 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3413 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3414 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3415 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3416 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3417 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3418 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3419
3420 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3421 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3422 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3423 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3424 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3425 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3426 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3427 persistence cookie in the cache.
3428 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3429
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003430 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3431 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3432 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3433 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3434 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003435 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003436 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3437 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3438 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3439 they logout.
3440
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003441 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3442 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3443 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3444 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3445
3446 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3447 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3448 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3449 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3450 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3451 this attribute.
3452
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003453 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003454 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003455 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3456 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3457 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3458 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3459 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3460 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003461
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003462 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3463 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3464 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3465 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3466 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3467 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3468 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3469 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003470 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003471 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3472 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3473 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3474 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3475 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3476 the site.
3477
3478 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3479 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3480 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3481 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3482 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3483 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3484 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3485 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3486 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3487 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3488 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3489 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3490 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003491 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003492 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3493 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3494
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003495 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3496 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3497 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3498 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3499 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3500 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3501
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003502 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3503 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3504 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3505 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003506
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003507 Examples :
3508 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3509 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3510 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003511 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003512
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003513 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003514
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003515
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003516declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3517 Declares a capture slot.
3518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3519 no | yes | yes | no
3520 Arguments:
3521 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3522
3523 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3524 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3525 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3526 for use in the response.
3527
3528 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003529 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003530 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3531
3532
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003533default-server [param*]
3534 Change default options for a server in a backend
3535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3536 yes | no | yes | yes
3537 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003538 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3539 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3540 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3541 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003542
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003543 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003544 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3545
3546 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003547
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003548
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003549default_backend <backend>
3550 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3552 yes | yes | yes | no
3553 Arguments :
3554 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3555
3556 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3557 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3558 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3559 will catch all undetermined requests.
3560
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003561 Example :
3562
3563 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3564 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3565 default_backend dynamic
3566
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003567 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003568
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003569
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003570description <string>
3571 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3573 no | yes | yes | yes
3574 Arguments : string
3575
3576 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3577 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3578 it describes.
3579 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3580
3581
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003582disabled
3583 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3585 yes | yes | yes | yes
3586 Arguments : none
3587
3588 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3589 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3590 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3591 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3592 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3593 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3594 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3595
3596 See also : "enabled"
3597
3598
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003599dispatch <address>:<port>
3600 Set a default server address
3601 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3602 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003603 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003604
3605 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3606 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3607 during start-up.
3608
3609 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3610 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3611 possible with normal servers.
3612
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003613 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003614 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3615 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3616 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3617 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3618
3619 See also : "server"
3620
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003621
3622dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3623 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3625 yes | no | yes | yes
3626 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3627
3628 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003629 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003630 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3631 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003632 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003633 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003634
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003635enabled
3636 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3638 yes | yes | yes | yes
3639 Arguments : none
3640
3641 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3642 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3643
3644 See also : "disabled"
3645
3646
3647errorfile <code> <file>
3648 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3649 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3650 yes | yes | yes | yes
3651 Arguments :
3652 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003653 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3654 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003655
3656 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003657 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003658 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003659 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3660 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003661
3662 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3663 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3664 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3665
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003666 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3667
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003668 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3669 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3670 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3671 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3672
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003673 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3674 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003675 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003676 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3677 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3678 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3679
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003680 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3681 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3682 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003683 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003684 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3685
3686 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3687
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003688 Example :
3689 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003690 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003691 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3692 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3693
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003694
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003695errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
3696 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
3697 section.
3698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3699 yes | yes | yes | yes
3700 Arguments :
3701 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
3702
3703 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
3704 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 403,
3705 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3706
3707 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
3708 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
3709 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
3710 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
3711 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
3712 ones. Fonctionnly, it is exactly the same than declaring all error files by
3713 hand using "errorfile" directives.
3714
3715 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" , "errorloc303" and section
3716 3.8 about http-errors.
3717
3718 Example :
3719 errorfiles generic
3720 errorfiles site-1 403 404
3721
3722
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003723errorloc <code> <url>
3724errorloc302 <code> <url>
3725 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3727 yes | yes | yes | yes
3728 Arguments :
3729 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003730 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3731 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003732
3733 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3734 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3735 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3736 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003737 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003738
3739 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3740 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3741 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3742
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003743 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3744
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003745 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3746 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3747 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3748 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003749 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003750 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3751 request.
3752
3753 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3754
3755
3756errorloc303 <code> <url>
3757 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3759 yes | yes | yes | yes
3760 Arguments :
3761 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003762 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3763 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003764
3765 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3766 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3767 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3768 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003769 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003770
3771 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3772 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3773 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3774
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003775 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3776
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003777 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3778 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3779 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3780 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003781 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003782
3783 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3784
3785
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003786email-alert from <emailaddr>
3787 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003788 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003789 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3790 yes | yes | yes | yes
3791
3792 Arguments :
3793
3794 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3795
3796 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3797 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3798
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003799 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003800 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3801 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003802
3803
3804email-alert level <level>
3805 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3806 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3807 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3808 yes | yes | yes | yes
3809
3810 Arguments :
3811
3812 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3813 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3814 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3815
3816 By default level is alert
3817
3818 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3819 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3820 for the proxy.
3821
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003822 Alerts are sent when :
3823
3824 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3825 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3826 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3827 is notice or lower
3828 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3829 and a health check status update occurs
3830
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003831 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3832 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003833 section 3.6 about mailers.
3834
3835
3836email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3837 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3838 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3839 yes | yes | yes | yes
3840
3841 Arguments :
3842
3843 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3844
3845 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3846 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3847
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003848 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3849 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003850
3851
3852email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3853 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3854 mailers.
3855 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3856 yes | yes | yes | yes
3857
3858 Arguments :
3859
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003860 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003861
3862 By default the systems hostname is used.
3863
3864 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3865 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3866 for the proxy.
3867
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003868 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3869 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003870
3871
3872email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003873 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003874 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3875 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3876 yes | yes | yes | yes
3877
3878 Arguments :
3879
3880 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3881
3882 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3883 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3884
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003885 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003886 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3887
3888
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003889force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3890 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3891 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003892 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003893
3894 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3895 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3896 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3897 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3898 marked down for maintenance operations.
3899
3900 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3901 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3902 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3903 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3904 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3905 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3906 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3907 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3908 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3909
3910 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3911 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3912 is used.
3913
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003914 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003915 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003916
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003917
3918filter <name> [param*]
3919 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3921 no | yes | yes | yes
3922 Arguments :
3923 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3924 referenced in section 9.
3925
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003926 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003927 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003928 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3929 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003930
3931 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3932 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3933
3934 Example:
3935 listen
3936 bind *:80
3937
3938 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3939 filter compression
3940 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3941
3942 compression algo gzip
3943 compression offload
3944
3945 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3946
3947 See also : section 9.
3948
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003949
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003950fullconn <conns>
3951 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3953 yes | no | yes | yes
3954 Arguments :
3955 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3956 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3957
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003958 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003959 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003960 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003961 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3962 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3963 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3964 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3965 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003966 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003967
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003968 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3969 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003970 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3971 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3972 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003973
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003974 Example :
3975 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3976 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3977 # connections.
3978 backend dynamic
3979 fullconn 10000
3980 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3981 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3982
3983 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3984
3985
3986grace <time>
3987 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003989 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003990 Arguments :
3991 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3992 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3993 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3994
3995 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3996 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003997 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003998 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3999
4000 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4001 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4002 simplify it.
4003
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004004
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004005hash-balance-factor <factor>
4006 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4008 yes | no | no | yes
4009 Arguments :
4010 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4011 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004012 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004013
4014 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4015 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4016 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4017 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4018 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4019 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4020 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4021
4022 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4023 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4024 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4025 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4026 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4027
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004028 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4029 consistent hashing mechanism.
4030
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004031 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4032
4033
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004034hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004035 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4037 yes | no | yes | yes
4038 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004039 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4040 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004041
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004042 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4043 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4044 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4045 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4046 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4047 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4048 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4049 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4050 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4051 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004052
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004053 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4054 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4055 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4056 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4057 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4058 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4059 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4060 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4061 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4062 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4063 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4064 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4065 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004066 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4067 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004068
4069 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4070
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004071 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004072 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4073 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4074 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004075 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4076 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4077 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004078
4079 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4080 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004081 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4082 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4083 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4084 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4085
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004086 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4087 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4088 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4089 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4090 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4091 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4092 parameter.
4093
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004094 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4095 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4096 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4097 used on strings.
4098
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004099 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4100
4101 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4102 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4103 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4104 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4105 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4106 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4107 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4108 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4109 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4110 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4111 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4112 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004113
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004114 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4115 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4116 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004117
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004118 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004119
4120
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004121http-check disable-on-404
4122 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004124 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004125 Arguments : none
4126
4127 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4128 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4129 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4130 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4131 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4132 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4133 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4134 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004135 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4136 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4137 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4138
4139 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4140
4141
4142http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004143 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004145 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004146 Arguments :
4147 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4148 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004149 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004150 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4151 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4152 details on the supported keywords.
4153
4154 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4155 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4156 with the usual backslash ('\').
4157
4158 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4159 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4160 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4161 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4162 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4163
4164 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004165 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004166 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4167 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4168 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4169
4170 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004171 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004172 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4173 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4174 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4175 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4176
4177 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004178 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004179 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4180 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4181 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4182 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4183 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004184 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004185 trace).
4186
4187 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004188 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004189 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4190 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4191 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4192 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4193 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004194 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004195
4196 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4197 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4198 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4199 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4200 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4201 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4202 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4203 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4204
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004205 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4206 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4207 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4208
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004209 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4210 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4211
4212 Examples :
4213 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004214 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004215
4216 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004217 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004218
4219 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004220 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004221
4222 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004223 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004224
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004225 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004226
4227
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004228http-check send-state
4229 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4230 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4231 yes | no | yes | yes
4232 Arguments : none
4233
4234 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4235 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4236 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4237 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4238 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4239
4240 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4241 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4242 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4243 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4244 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004245 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4246 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4247 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4248
4249 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4250 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4251 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4252
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004253 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4254 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4255 checked in multiple backends.
4256
4257 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4258 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4259
4260 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4261 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4262 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4263 one fails.
4264
4265 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4266 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4267 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4268
4269 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4270 server's queue.
4271
4272 Example of a header received by the application server :
4273 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4274 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4275
4276 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4277
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004278
4279http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004280 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4281
4282 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4283 no | yes | yes | yes
4284
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004285 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4286 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4287 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4288 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4289 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004290
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004291 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4292 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004293
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004294 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004295
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004296 Example:
4297 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4298 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4299 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004300
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004301 http-request allow if nagios
4302 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4303 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4304 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004305
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004306 Example:
4307 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4308 acl add path /addacl
4309 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004310
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004311 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004312
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004313 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4314 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004315
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004316 Example:
4317 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4318 acl setmap path /setmap
4319 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004320
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004321 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004322
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004323 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4324 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004325
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004326 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4327 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004328
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004329http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004330
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004331 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4332 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4333 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4334 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4335 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4336 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4337 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4338 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004339
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004340http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004341
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004342 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4343 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4344 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4345 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4346 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4347 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4348 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4349 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004350
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004351http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004352
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004353 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4354 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004355
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004356
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004357http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004358
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004359 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4360 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4361 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4362 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4363 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004364
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004365 Example:
4366 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4367 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004368
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004369http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004370
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004371 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004372
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004373http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4374 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004375
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004376 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4377 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4378 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4379 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4380 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4381 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4382 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4383 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4384 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004385
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004386 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4387 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4388 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4389 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4390 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4391 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004392
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004393http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004394
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004395 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4396 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4397 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4398 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4399 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4400 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004401
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004402http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004403
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004404 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004405
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004406http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004407
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004408 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4409 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4410 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4411 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4412 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4413 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004414
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004415http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004416
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004417 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4418 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4419 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4420 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4421 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004422
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004423http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4424 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4425 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4426 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4427
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004428http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4429
4430 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4431 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4432 pointed by <resolvers>.
4433 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4434 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4435 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4436 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4437 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4438 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4439 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4440 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4441 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4442 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4443 to 0.0.0.0.
4444
4445 Example:
4446 resolvers mydns
4447 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4448 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4449 timeout retry 1s
4450 hold valid 10s
4451 hold nx 3s
4452 hold other 3s
4453 hold obsolete 0s
4454 accepted_payload_size 8192
4455
4456 frontend fe
4457 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4458 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4459 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4460
4461 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4462 # which mean DNS resolution error
4463 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4464
4465 default_backend be
4466
4467 backend b_503
4468 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4469 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4470 # 503 error page to end users
4471
4472 backend be
4473 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4474 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4475 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4476 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4477 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4478
4479 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4480 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4481
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004482http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4483
4484 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4485 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4486 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4487 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004488 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4489 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004490
4491 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4492
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004493http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004494
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004495 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4496 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4497 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4498 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4499 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004500
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004501http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004502
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004503 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4504 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4505 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4506 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004507
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004508http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4509 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004510
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004511 This matches the value of all occurences of header field <name> against
4512 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
4513 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
4514 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
4515 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
4516 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004517
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004518 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
4519 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
4520 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
4521 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
4522 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004523
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004524 Example:
4525 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4526
4527 # applied to:
4528 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4529
4530 # outputs:
4531 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4532
4533 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004534
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004535 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
4536
4537 # applied to:
4538 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004539
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004540 # outputs:
4541 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004542
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004543http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4544 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4545
4546 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
4547 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
4548 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
4549 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
4550
4551 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4552 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4553 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
4554
4555 Example:
4556 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4557 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
4558
4559 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
4560 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
4561
4562 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4563 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
4564 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4565 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
4566
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004567http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4568 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4569
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004570 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
4571 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
4572 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
4573 against.
4574
4575 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4576 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4577 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004578
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004579 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
4580 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
4581 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
4582 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
4583 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
4584 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
4585 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
4586 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
4587 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004588 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
4589 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004590
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004591 Example:
4592 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
4593 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004594
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004595 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4596 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004597
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004598http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4599 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004600
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004601 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4602 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4603 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4604 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004605
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004606 Example:
4607 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004608
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004609 # applied to:
4610 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004611
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004612 # outputs:
4613 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004614
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004615http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4616http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004617
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004618 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4619 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4620 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004621
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004622http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
4623 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004624
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004625 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
4626 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
4627 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
4628 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004629
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004630http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004631
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004632 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4633 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4634 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4635 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4636 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004637
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004638 Arguments:
4639 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4640 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004641
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004642 Example:
4643 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4644 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004645
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004646 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4647 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004648
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004649http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004650
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004651 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4652 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4653 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004654
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004655 Arguments:
4656 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4657 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004658
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004659 Example:
4660 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4661 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004662
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004663 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4664 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4665 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004666
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004667http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004668
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004669 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4670 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4671 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4672 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4673 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004674
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004675 Example:
4676 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4677 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4678 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4679 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4680 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4681 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4682 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4683 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4684 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004685
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004686http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004687
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004688 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4689 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4690 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4691 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4692 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004693
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004694http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4695 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004696
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004697 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4698 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4699 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4700 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4701 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4702 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4703 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4704 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4705 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004706
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004707http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004708
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004709 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4710 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4711 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4712 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4713 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4714 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4715 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004716
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004717http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004718
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004719 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4720 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4721 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004722
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004723http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004724
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004725 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4726 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4727 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4728 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4729 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4730 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4731 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4732 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004733
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004734http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004735
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004736 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4737 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4738 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4739 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4740 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4741 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004742
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004743 Example :
4744 # prepend the host name before the path
4745 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004746
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004747http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004748
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004749 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4750 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4751 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4752 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4753 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004754
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004755http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004756
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004757 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4758 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4759 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4760 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4761 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4762 values have higher priority.
4763 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4764 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4765 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4766 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4767 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004768
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004769http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004770
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004771 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4772 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4773 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4774 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4775 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4776 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4777 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004778
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004779 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004780
4781 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004782 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4783 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004784
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004785http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4786 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4787 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4788 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4789 privacy.
4790
4791 Arguments :
4792 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4793 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004794
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004795 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004796 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4797 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4798
4799 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4800 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4801
4802http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4803
4804 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4805 expression.
4806
4807 Arguments:
4808 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4809 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004810
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004811 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004812 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4813 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4814
4815 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4816 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4817 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4818
4819http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4820
4821 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4822 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4823 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4824 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4825 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4826 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4827 information from the request.
4828
4829 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4830
4831http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4832
4833 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4834 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4835 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4836 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4837 path and the query string.
4838 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4839
4840http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4841
4842 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4843 inline.
4844
4845 Arguments:
4846 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4847 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4848 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4849 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4850 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4851 (request and response)
4852 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4853 processing
4854 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4855 processing
4856 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4857 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4858 and '_'.
4859
4860 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4861 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004862
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004863 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004864 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004865
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004866http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4867 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004868
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004869 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4870 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4871 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4872 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4873 agent name must be used.
4874
4875 Arguments:
4876 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4877
4878 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4879 configuration.
4880
4881http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4882
4883 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4884 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4885 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4886 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4887 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4888 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4889 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4890 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4891 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4892 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4893 action.
4894 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4895 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4896 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4897 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4898 you fully understand how it works.
4899
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01004900http-request strict-mode { on | off }
4901
4902 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4903 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4904 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4905 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4906 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
4907 rewrites optionnal while others must be performed to continue the request
4908 processing.
4909
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01004910 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01004911 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
4912 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
4913 rules evaluation.
4914
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004915http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4916
4917 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4918 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4919 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4920 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4921 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4922 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4923 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4924 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4925 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4926 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4927 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4928 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4929 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4930
4931http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4932http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4933http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4934
4935 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4936 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4937 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4938 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4939 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4940 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4941 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4942 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4943 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4944 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4945 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4946 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4947
4948 Arguments :
4949 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4950 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4951 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4952 select which table entry to update the counters.
4953
4954 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4955 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4956 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4957 that table until the session ends.
4958
4959 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4960 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4961 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4962 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4963 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4964 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4965 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4966 useful information.
4967
4968 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4969 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4970 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4971 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4972 checks that make use of it.
4973
4974http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4975
4976 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004977
4978 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004979 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004980
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01004981http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4982
4983 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
4984 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
4985 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
4986 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
4987 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
4988 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
4989
4990 Arguments :
4991 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
4992
4993 Example:
4994 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
4995
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004996http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004997
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004998 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4999 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
5000 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005001
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005002
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005003http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005004 Access control for Layer 7 responses
5005
5006 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5007 no | yes | yes | yes
5008
5009 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5010 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5011 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5012 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5013 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5014 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5015
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005016 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5017 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005018
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005019 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005020
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005021 Example:
5022 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005023
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005024 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005025
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005026 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5027 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005028
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005029 Example:
5030 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005031
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005032 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005033
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005034 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5035 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005036
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005037 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5038 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005039
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005040http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005041
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005042 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5043 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5044 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5045 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5046 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5047 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5048 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5049 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005050
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005051http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005052
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005053 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5054 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5055 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5056 example, or to pass some internal information.
5057 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5058 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5059 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005060
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005061http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005062
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005063 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5064 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005065
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005066http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005067
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005068 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005069
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005070http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005071
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005072 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5073 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5074 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5075 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5076 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5077 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5078 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005079
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005080 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5081 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5082 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5083 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5084 keyword.
5085 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
5086 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005087
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005088http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005089
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005090 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5091 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5092 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5093 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5094 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5095 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005096
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005097http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005098
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005099 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005100
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005101http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005102
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005103 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5104 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5105 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5106 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5107 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5108 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005109
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005110http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005111
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005112 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
5113 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005114
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005115http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005116
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005117 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5118 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5119 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5120 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5121 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5122 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005123
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005124http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5125 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005126
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005127 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5128 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005129
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005130 Example:
5131 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005132
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005133 # applied to:
5134 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005135
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005136 # outputs:
5137 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005138
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005139 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005140
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005141http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5142 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005143
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01005144 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005145 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005146
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005147 Example:
5148 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005149
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005150 # applied to:
5151 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005152
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005153 # outputs:
5154 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005155
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005156http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5157http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005158
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005159 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5160 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5161 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005162
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005163http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5164 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005165
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005166 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5167 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5168 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5169 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005170
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005171http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005172
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005173 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5174 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5175 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5176 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5177 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005178
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005179 Arguments:
5180 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005181
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005182 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5183 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005184
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005185http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005186
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005187 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5188 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5189 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005190
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005191http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5192
5193 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5194 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5195 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5196 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5197 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5198
5199http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5200
5201 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5202 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5203 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5204 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5205 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5206 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5207 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5208 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5209 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5210
5211http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5212
5213 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5214 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5215 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5216 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5217 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5218 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5219 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5220
5221http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5222
5223 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5224 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5225 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5226 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5227 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5228 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5229 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5230 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5231
5232http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5233 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5234
5235 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5236 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5237 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5238 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005239
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005240 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005241 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5242 http-response set-status 431
5243 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5244 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005245
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005246http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005247
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005248 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5249 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5250 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5251 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5252 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5253 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5254 based on some information from the request.
5255
5256 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5257
5258http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5259
5260 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5261 inline.
5262
5263 Arguments:
5264 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5265 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5266 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5267 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5268 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5269 (request and response)
5270 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5271 processing
5272 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5273 processing
5274 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5275 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5276 and '_'.
5277
5278 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5279 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005280
5281 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005282 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005283
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005284http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005285
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005286 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5287 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5288 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5289 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5290 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5291 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5292 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5293 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5294 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5295 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5296 action.
5297 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5298 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5299 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5300 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5301 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005302
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005303http-response strict-mode { on | off }
5304
5305 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5306 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5307 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5308 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5309 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
5310 rewrites optionnal while others must be performed to continue the response
5311 processing.
5312
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005313 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005314 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5315 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
5316 rules evaluation.
5317
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005318http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5319http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5320http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005321
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005322 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5323 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5324 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5325 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5326 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5327 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5328
5329http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5330
5331 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5332 about <var-name>.
5333
5334 Example:
5335 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5336
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005337
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005338http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5339 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5340
5341 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5342 yes | no | yes | yes
5343
5344 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005345 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5346 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5347 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005348
5349 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5350
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005351 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5352 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5353 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5354 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5355 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5356 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5357 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5358 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5359 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5360 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005361
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005362 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5363 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5364 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5365 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5366 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5367 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5368 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5369 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005370
5371 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5372 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5373 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5374 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5375 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5376 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5377 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5378 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005379 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005380 downsides of rare connection failures.
5381
5382 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5383 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5384 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5385 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5386 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5387 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005388 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005389 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5390 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5391 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5392 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5393 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5394
5395 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005396 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5397 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5398 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005399
5400 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005401 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005402
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005403 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5404 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005405
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01005406 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005407
5408 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5409 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5410 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5411
5412 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5413
5414
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005415http-send-name-header [<header>]
5416 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005417 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5418 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005419 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005420 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5421
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005422 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5423 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5424 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5425 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5426 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5427 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5428 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5429 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5430 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5431 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5432 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5433 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5434 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5435 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5436 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5437 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005438
5439 See also : "server"
5440
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005441id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005442 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5444 no | yes | yes | yes
5445 Arguments : none
5446
5447 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5448 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5449 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005450
5451
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005452ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5453 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5454 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005455 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005456
5457 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5458 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5459 and running).
5460
5461 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5462 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5463 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005464 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005465 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5466
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005467 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5468 "unless" condition is met.
5469
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005470 Example:
5471 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5472 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5473 ignore-persist if url_static
5474
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005475 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5476
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005477load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5478 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5479 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5480 yes | no | yes | yes
5481
5482 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5483 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5484 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005485 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005486 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5487 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5488 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5489 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5490
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005491 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005492 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005493 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005494
5495 Arguments:
5496 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5497 named "server-state-file".
5498
5499 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5500 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5501 name is used as a file name.
5502
5503 none don't load any stat for this backend
5504
5505 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005506 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5507 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5508 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005509 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005510 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005511
5512 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5513 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5514
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005515 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005516
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005517 global
5518 stats socket /tmp/socket
5519 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005520
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005521 defaults
5522 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005523
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005524 backend bk
5525 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5526 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005527
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005528
5529 Then one can run :
5530
5531 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5532
5533 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5534
5535 1
5536 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5537 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5538 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5539
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005540 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005541
5542 global
5543 stats socket /tmp/socket
5544 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5545
5546 defaults
5547 load-server-state-from-file local
5548
5549 backend bk
5550 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5551 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5552
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005553
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005554 Then one can run :
5555
5556 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5557
5558 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5559
5560 1
5561 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5562 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5563 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5564
5565 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5566 "show servers state"
5567
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005568
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005569log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005570log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5571 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005572no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005573 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5575 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005576
5577 Prefix :
5578 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5579 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5580 prefix does not allow arguments.
5581
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005582 Arguments :
5583 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5584 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5585 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5586 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5587 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5588 parameter.
5589
5590 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5591 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5592
5593 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5594 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5595 standard syslog port).
5596
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005597 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5598 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5599 standard syslog port).
5600
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005601 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5602 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5603 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005604 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005605
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005606 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5607 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5608 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5609 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5610 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5611 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5612 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5613 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5614 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5615 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5616 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5617 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5618 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5619 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5620 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5621 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005622 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5623 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005624
5625 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5626 and "fd@2", see above.
5627
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02005628 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
5629 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
5630 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
5631 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
5632 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
5633 having the logs instantly available.
5634
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005635 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5636 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005637
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005638 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5639 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5640 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5641 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5642 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5643 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5644 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5645 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5646 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5647 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005648 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005649
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005650 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5651 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5652 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5653 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5654 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5655
5656 <sample_size>
5657 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5658 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5659 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5660 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5661 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5662
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005663 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5664 one of the following :
5665
5666 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5667 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5668
5669 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5670 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5671
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005672 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5673 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5674 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5675 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5676 systemd logger consumes.
5677
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005678 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5679 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5680 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5681 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5682
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005683 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5684
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005685 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5686 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5687 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5688
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005689 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5690 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5691 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5692 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005693
5694 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5695 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5696 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005697 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5698 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5699 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5700 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5701 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005702
5703 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5704
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005705 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5706 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5707 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005708
5709 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5710 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5711 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5712 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5713
5714 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5715 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005716
5717 Example :
5718 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005719 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5720 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5721 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005722 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5723 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005724 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005725
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005726
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005727log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005728 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5729 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5730 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005731
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005732 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5733 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5734 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5735 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5736 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005737
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005738 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5739 "option httplog" directives.
5740
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005741log-format-sd <string>
5742 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5743 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5744 yes | yes | yes | no
5745
5746 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5747 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5748 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5749 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5750 which covers the log format string in depth.
5751
5752 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5753 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5754
5755 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5756 log format to "rfc5424".
5757
5758 Example :
5759 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5760
5761
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005762log-tag <string>
5763 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5764 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5765 yes | yes | yes | yes
5766
5767 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5768 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5769 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5770 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5771 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5772 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5773 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5774 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5775 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005776
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005777max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5778 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5779 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5780 yes | no | yes | yes
5781
5782 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5783 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5784 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5785 servers.
5786
5787 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5788 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5789 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5790 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5791 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005792 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005793 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5794 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5795 picking a different server.
5796
5797 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5798 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5799 even if they have to be queued.
5800
5801 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5802 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5803
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005804max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5805 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5806 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5807 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005808
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005809maxconn <conns>
5810 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5812 yes | yes | yes | no
5813 Arguments :
5814 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5815 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5816 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5817 closes.
5818
5819 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5820 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5821 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5822 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005823 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5824 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5825 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5826 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005827
5828 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5829 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5830 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5831
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005832 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5833 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005834
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005835 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5836
5837
5838mode { tcp|http|health }
5839 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5840 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5841 yes | yes | yes | yes
5842 Arguments :
5843 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5844 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5845 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5846 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5847
5848 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5849 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5850 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5851 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5852 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5853
5854 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005855 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5856 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5857 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5858 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5859 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5860 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5861 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005862
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005863 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5864 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5865 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005866
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005867 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005868 defaults http_instances
5869 mode http
5870
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005871 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005872
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005873
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005874monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005875 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5877 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005878 Arguments :
5879 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5880 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005881 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005882 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5883 backend and its backup.
5884
5885 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5886 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5887 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5888 servers in a list of backends.
5889
5890 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5891 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5892 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5893 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5894 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5895 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5896 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005897 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5898 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005899
5900 Example:
5901 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005902 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005903 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5904 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5905 monitor-uri /site_alive
5906 monitor fail if site_dead
5907
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005908 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005909
5910
5911monitor-net <source>
5912 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5914 yes | yes | yes | no
5915 Arguments :
5916 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5917 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5918 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5919 followed by a mask.
5920
5921 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5922 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005923 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005924 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5925
5926 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5927 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5928 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5929 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005930 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5931 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5932 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005933
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005934 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5935 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5936 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5937 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5938 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5939 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005940
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005941 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5942 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005943
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005944 Example :
5945 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5946 frontend www
5947 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5948
5949 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5950
5951
5952monitor-uri <uri>
5953 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5954 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5955 yes | yes | yes | no
5956 Arguments :
5957 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5958 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5959
5960 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5961 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5962 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5963 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5964 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5965 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5966 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5967 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5968
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005969 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005970 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
5971 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
5972 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
5973 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
5974 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
5975 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005976
5977 Example :
5978 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5979 frontend www
5980 mode http
5981 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5982
5983 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5984
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005985
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005986option abortonclose
5987no option abortonclose
5988 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5990 yes | no | yes | yes
5991 Arguments : none
5992
5993 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5994 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5995 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5996 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005997 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005998 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5999 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
6000 encountered while delivering the response.
6001
6002 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
6003 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
6004 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
6005 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
6006 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
6007 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006008 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006009 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006010 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006011 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
6012 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
6013 still not served and not pollute the servers.
6014
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006015 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
6016 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006017 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
6018 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
6019 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
6020 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
6021 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
6022 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006023 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006024
6025 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6026 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6027
6028 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
6029
6030
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006031option accept-invalid-http-request
6032no option accept-invalid-http-request
6033 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
6034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6035 yes | yes | yes | no
6036 Arguments : none
6037
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006038 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006039 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006040 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006041 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6042 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6043 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6044 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6045 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006046 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
6047 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
6048 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
6049 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006050 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006051 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02006052 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
6053 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
6054 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006055
6056 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6057 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6058 been confirmed.
6059
6060 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6061 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006062 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
6063 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006064 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6065
6066 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6067 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6068
6069 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
6070 stats socket.
6071
6072
6073option accept-invalid-http-response
6074no option accept-invalid-http-response
6075 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
6076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6077 yes | no | yes | yes
6078 Arguments : none
6079
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006080 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006081 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006082 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006083 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6084 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6085 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6086 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6087 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006088 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
6089 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
6090 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006091
6092 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6093 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6094 been confirmed.
6095
6096 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6097 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
6098 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
6099 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6100
6101 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6102 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6103
6104 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
6105 stats socket.
6106
6107
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006108option allbackups
6109no option allbackups
6110 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
6111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6112 yes | no | yes | yes
6113 Arguments : none
6114
6115 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
6116 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
6117 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
6118 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
6119 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
6120 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
6121 order between the backup servers anymore.
6122
6123 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
6124 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
6125
6126 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6127 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6128
6129
6130option checkcache
6131no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006132 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6134 yes | no | yes | yes
6135 Arguments : none
6136
6137 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6138 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006139 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006140 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6141 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006142 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006143
6144 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006145 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006146 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006147 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6148 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006149 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006150 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006151 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6152 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006153 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006154 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6155 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006156 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006157 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6158 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6159 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6160 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6161 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6162 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6163 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6164 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6165 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6166
6167 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006168 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
6169 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
6170 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
6171 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006172
6173 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6174 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006175 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006176 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006177
6178 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6179 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6180
6181
6182option clitcpka
6183no option clitcpka
6184 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6186 yes | yes | yes | no
6187 Arguments : none
6188
6189 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6190 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006191 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006192 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6193
6194 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6195 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6196 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6197 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6198
6199 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6200 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6201 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6202 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6203 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6204
6205 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6206
6207 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6208 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6209 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6210
6211 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6212 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6213
6214 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6215
6216
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006217option contstats
6218 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6220 yes | yes | yes | no
6221 Arguments : none
6222
6223 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6224 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6225 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6226 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006227 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6228 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6229 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6230 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6231 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006232
6233
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006234option dontlog-normal
6235no option dontlog-normal
6236 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6237 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6238 yes | yes | yes | no
6239 Arguments : none
6240
6241 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6242 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6243 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6244 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6245 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6246 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6247 logged.
6248
6249 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6250 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6251 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6252
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006253 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006254 logging.
6255
6256
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006257option dontlognull
6258no option dontlognull
6259 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6261 yes | yes | yes | no
6262 Arguments : none
6263
6264 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6265 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6266 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6267 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6268 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6269 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006270 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6271 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6272 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006273
6274 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006275 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006276 would not be logged.
6277
6278 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6279 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6280
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006281 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6282 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006283
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006284
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006285option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006286 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6288 yes | yes | yes | yes
6289 Arguments :
6290 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6291 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006292 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006293 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006294
6295 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6296 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6297 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6298 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6299 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6300 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6301 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006302 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6303 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6304 possible that the client has already brought one.
6305
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006306 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006307 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006308 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006309 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006310 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006311 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006312
6313 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6314 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6315 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6316 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6317 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6318 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6319 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6320
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006321 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6322 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6323 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6324 are under the control of the end-user.
6325
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006326 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006327 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6328 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006329 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6330 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6331 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006332
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006333 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006334 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6335 frontend www
6336 mode http
6337 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6338
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006339 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6340 backend www
6341 mode http
6342 option forwardfor header X-Client
6343
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006344 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006345 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006346
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006347
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006348option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6349no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6350 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6352 yes | yes | yes | no
6353 Arguments : none
6354
6355 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6356 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6357 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6358 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6359 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6360 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6361 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6362
6363 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6364 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6365 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6366 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6367 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6368 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6369 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6370 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6371 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6372 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6373
6374 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6375
6376 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6377 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6378
6379 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6380 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6381
6382
6383option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6384no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6385 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6387 yes | no | yes | yes
6388 Arguments : none
6389
6390 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6391 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6392 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6393 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6394 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6395 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6396 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6397
6398 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6399 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6400 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6401 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6402 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6403 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6404 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6405 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6406 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6407 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6408
6409 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6410
6411 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6412 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6413
6414 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6415 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6416
6417
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006418option http-buffer-request
6419no option http-buffer-request
6420 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6422 yes | yes | yes | yes
6423 Arguments : none
6424
6425 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6426 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6427 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6428 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6429 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6430 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01006431 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
6432 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
6433 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
6434 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006435
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006436 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006437
6438
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006439option http-ignore-probes
6440no option http-ignore-probes
6441 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6443 yes | yes | yes | no
6444 Arguments : none
6445
6446 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6447 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6448 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6449 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6450 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6451 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6452 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6453 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6454 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006455 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6456 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006457 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6458
6459 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6460 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6461 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6462 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6463 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6464 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6465 are often the only way to detect them.
6466
6467 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6468 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6469
6470 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6471
6472
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006473option http-keep-alive
6474no option http-keep-alive
6475 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6476 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6477 yes | yes | yes | yes
6478 Arguments : none
6479
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006480 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6481 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006482 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6483 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006484 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
6485 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
6486 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006487
6488 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6489 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006490 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6491 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6492 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6493 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6494 situations where this option may be useful :
6495
6496 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006497 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006498
6499 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6500 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6501
6502 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6503 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6504 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6505 request.
6506
6507 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6508 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006509 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6510 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6511 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006512
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006513 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6514 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6515 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6516 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6517 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6518 not set.
6519
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006520 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6521 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
6522 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006523
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006524 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006525 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006526 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006527
6528
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006529option http-no-delay
6530no option http-no-delay
6531 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6533 yes | yes | yes | yes
6534 Arguments : none
6535
6536 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6537 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6538 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6539 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6540 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6541 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6542 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6543 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6544 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6545 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6546 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6547 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6548 affected.
6549
6550 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6551 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6552 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6553 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6554 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6555 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6556 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6557 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6558 latency environments.
6559
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006560 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6561
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006562
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006563option http-pretend-keepalive
6564no option http-pretend-keepalive
6565 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006567 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006568 Arguments : none
6569
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006570 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006571 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6572 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6573 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6574 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6575 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6576 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6577 consider the response complete.
6578
6579 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6580 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6581 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6582 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006583 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006584 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6585
6586 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6587 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6588 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6589 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6590 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6591 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6592 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6593
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006594 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6595 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6596 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6597 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6598 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6599 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006600
6601 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6602 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6603
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006604 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006605 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006606
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006607
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006608option http-server-close
6609no option http-server-close
6610 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6612 yes | yes | yes | yes
6613 Arguments : none
6614
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006615 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6616 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6617 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6618 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006619 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
6620 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
6621 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
6622 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
6623 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
6624 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
6625 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
6626 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
6627 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
6628 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
6629 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006630
6631 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6632 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6633 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6634 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006635 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6636 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006637
6638 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6639 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006640 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6641 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
6642 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006643
6644 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6645 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6646
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006647 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6648 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006649
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006650option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006651no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006652 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6654 yes | yes | yes | no
6655 Arguments : none
6656
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006657 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006658 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6659 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6660 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6661 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6662 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6663 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6664
6665 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6666 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006667 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6668 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6669 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006670
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006671 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6672 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6673 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6674 front of an existing proxy.
6675
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006676 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6677
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006678 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006679
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006680option httpchk
6681option httpchk <uri>
6682option httpchk <method> <uri>
6683option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6684 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6686 yes | no | yes | yes
6687 Arguments :
6688 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6689 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6690 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6691 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6692 ones.
6693
6694 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6695 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6696 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6697
6698 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6699 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6700 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6701 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6702 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6703
6704 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6705 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6706 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6707 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6708 the lack of any response.
6709
6710 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6711
6712 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6713 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6714 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6715
6716 Examples :
6717 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6718 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6719 backend https_relay
6720 mode tcp
6721 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6722 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6723
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006724 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6725 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6726 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006727
6728
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006729option httpclose
6730no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006731 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6733 yes | yes | yes | yes
6734 Arguments : none
6735
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006736 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6737 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6738 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6739 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006740 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006741
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006742 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6743 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05006744 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006745 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6746 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006747
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006748 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6749 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6750 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006751
6752 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6753 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006754 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
6755 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
6756 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006757
6758 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6759 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6760
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006761 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006762
6763
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006764option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006765 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006767 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006768 Arguments :
6769 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6770 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6771 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006772 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006773 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006774
6775 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6776 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6777 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6778 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6779 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6780 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6781 ports.
6782
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006783 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6784 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006785
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006786 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6787
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006788 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006789
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006790
6791option http_proxy
6792no option http_proxy
6793 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6795 yes | yes | yes | yes
6796 Arguments : none
6797
6798 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6799 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6800 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6801 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6802 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6803
6804 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6805 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006806 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6807 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006808
6809 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6810 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6811
6812 Example :
6813 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6814 backend direct_forward
6815 option httpclose
6816 option http_proxy
6817
6818 See also : "option httpclose"
6819
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006820
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006821option independent-streams
6822no option independent-streams
6823 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6825 yes | yes | yes | yes
6826 Arguments : none
6827
6828 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6829 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6830 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6831 receive data or not.
6832
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006833 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006834 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6835 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6836 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6837 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6838 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6839 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6840 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6841 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6842 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6843 socket buffers.
6844
6845 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6846 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6847 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6848 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6849 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6850
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006851 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006852
6853
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006854option ldap-check
6855 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6857 yes | no | yes | yes
6858 Arguments : none
6859
6860 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6861 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6862 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6863 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6864
6865 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6866 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6867
6868 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6869 configure it.
6870
6871 Example :
6872 option ldap-check
6873
6874 See also : "option httpchk"
6875
6876
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006877option external-check
6878 Use external processes for server health checks
6879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6880 yes | no | yes | yes
6881
6882 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6883 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6884 command".
6885
6886 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6887
6888 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6889
6890
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006891option log-health-checks
6892no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006893 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6895 yes | no | yes | yes
6896 Arguments : none
6897
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006898 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6899 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6900 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006901
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006902 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6903 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6904 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6905 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6906 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6907
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006908 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006909 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006910
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006911 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6912 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6913 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006914
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006915
6916option log-separate-errors
6917no option log-separate-errors
6918 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6920 yes | yes | yes | no
6921 Arguments : none
6922
6923 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6924 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6925 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6926 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6927 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6928 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6929 provides very important information.
6930
6931 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6932 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6933 error logs.
6934
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006935 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006936 logging.
6937
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006938
6939option logasap
6940no option logasap
6941 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6943 yes | yes | yes | no
6944 Arguments : none
6945
6946 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6947 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6948 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6949 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6950 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6951 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6952 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006953 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006954 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6955 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6956
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006957 Examples :
6958 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6959 mode http
6960 option httplog
6961 option logasap
6962 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6963
6964 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6965 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6966 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6967 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6968
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006969 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006970 logging.
6971
6972
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006973option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006974 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6976 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006977 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006978 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6979 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006980 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006981
6982 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6983 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006984 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006985 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6986 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6987 in the MySQL table, like this :
6988
6989 USE mysql;
6990 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6991 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6992
6993 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006994 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006995 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6996 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6997 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6998 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6999 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
7000 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
7001 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
7002
7003 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
7004 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007005
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02007006 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007007
7008 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
7009 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
7010 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7011 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007012 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
7013 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007014
7015 See also: "option httpchk"
7016
7017
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007018option nolinger
7019no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007020 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007021 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7022 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007023 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007024
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007025 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007026 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
7027 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
7028 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
7029 connections.
7030
7031 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
7032 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
7033 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
7034 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
7035 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
7036 this too.
7037
7038 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
7039 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
7040 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
7041
7042 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
7043 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
7044 for servers.
7045
7046 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7047 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7048
7049
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007050option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
7051 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
7052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7053 yes | yes | yes | yes
7054 Arguments :
7055 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7056 matching <network>
7057 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
7058 header name.
7059
7060 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
7061 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
7062 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
7063 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
7064 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
7065 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
7066 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
7067 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
7068 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7069 possible that the client has already brought one.
7070
7071 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
7072 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
7073 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
7074 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
7075 header and requires different one.
7076
7077 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7078 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7079 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7080 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7081 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7082 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7083 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7084
7085 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
7086 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7087 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
7088 both are defined.
7089
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007090 Examples :
7091 # Original Destination address
7092 frontend www
7093 mode http
7094 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
7095
7096 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
7097 backend www
7098 mode http
7099 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
7100
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007101 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007102
7103
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007104option persist
7105no option persist
7106 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
7107 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7108 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007109 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007110
7111 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
7112 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
7113 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
7114 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
7115 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
7116 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
7117 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
7118 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
7119 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
7120 redirected to another valid server.
7121
7122 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7123 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7124
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007125 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007126
7127
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01007128option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7129 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7131 yes | no | yes | yes
7132 Arguments :
7133 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7134 PostgreSQL server.
7135
7136 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7137 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7138 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7139 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7140
7141 See also: "option httpchk"
7142
7143
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007144option prefer-last-server
7145no option prefer-last-server
7146 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7147 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7148 yes | no | yes | yes
7149 Arguments : none
7150
7151 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7152 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7153 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7154 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7155 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7156 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7157 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7158 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7159 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007160 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7161 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007162 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7163 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7164 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007165 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7166 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7167 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007168
7169 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7170 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7171
7172 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7173
7174
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007175option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007176option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007177no option redispatch
7178 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7179 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7180 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007181 Arguments :
7182 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7183 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7184 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007185 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007186 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007187 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007188 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7189 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7190 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7191
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007192
7193 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7194 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7195 be able to access the service anymore.
7196
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007197 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7198 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007199
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007200 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007201 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7202 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007203
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007204 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7205 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7206
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007207 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007208
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007209
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007210option redis-check
7211 Use redis health checks for server testing
7212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7213 yes | no | yes | yes
7214 Arguments : none
7215
7216 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7217 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7218 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7219 find the "+PONG" response message.
7220
7221 Example :
7222 option redis-check
7223
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007224 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007225
7226
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007227option smtpchk
7228option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7229 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7230 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7231 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007232 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007233 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007234 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007235 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7236
7237 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7238 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7239 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7240
7241 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7242 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7243 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7244 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7245 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7246 dead server.
7247
7248 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7249 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007250 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007251 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7252
7253 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7254 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7255 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7256 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007257 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007258
7259 Example :
7260 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7261
7262 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7263
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007264
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007265option socket-stats
7266no option socket-stats
7267
7268 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7270 yes | yes | yes | no
7271
7272 Arguments : none
7273
7274
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007275option splice-auto
7276no option splice-auto
7277 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7279 yes | yes | yes | yes
7280 Arguments : none
7281
7282 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7283 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007284 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007285 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007286 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007287 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7288 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7289 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7290 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7291
7292 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7293 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7294 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7295 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7296 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7297 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7298 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7299 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7300 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7301 keyword.
7302
7303 Example :
7304 option splice-auto
7305
7306 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7307 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7308
7309 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7310 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7311
7312
7313option splice-request
7314no option splice-request
7315 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7317 yes | yes | yes | yes
7318 Arguments : none
7319
7320 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007321 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007322 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7323 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7324 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7325 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7326
7327 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7328
7329 Example :
7330 option splice-request
7331
7332 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7333 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7334
7335 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7336 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7337
7338
7339option splice-response
7340no option splice-response
7341 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7343 yes | yes | yes | yes
7344 Arguments : none
7345
7346 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007347 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007348 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7349 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7350 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7351 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7352
7353 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7354
7355 Example :
7356 option splice-response
7357
7358 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7359 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7360
7361 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7362 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7363
7364
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007365option spop-check
7366 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7367 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7368 no | no | no | yes
7369 Arguments : none
7370
7371 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7372 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7373 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7374 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7375
7376 Example :
7377 option spop-check
7378
7379 See also : "option httpchk"
7380
7381
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007382option srvtcpka
7383no option srvtcpka
7384 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7386 yes | no | yes | yes
7387 Arguments : none
7388
7389 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7390 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007391 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007392 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7393
7394 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7395 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7396 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7397 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7398
7399 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7400 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7401 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7402 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7403 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7404
7405 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7406
7407 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7408 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7409 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7410
7411 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7412 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7413
7414 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7415
7416
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007417option ssl-hello-chk
7418 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7419 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7420 yes | no | yes | yes
7421 Arguments : none
7422
7423 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7424 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7425 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7426 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7427 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7428 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7429 hello message.
7430
7431 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7432 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7433 messages, which is appreciable.
7434
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007435 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7436 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7437 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007438
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007439 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7440
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007441
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007442option tcp-check
7443 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7444 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7445 yes | no | yes | yes
7446
7447 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7448 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7449
7450 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7451 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7452 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7453
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007454 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007455 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7456 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7457 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7458 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7459 only.
7460
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007461 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007462 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7463 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7464 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7465 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7466
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007467 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007468 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7469 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007470 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007471 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7472 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7473 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7474 the respective protocols.
7475 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007476 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007477
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007478 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7479 script.
7480
7481 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7482 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7483 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7484 The "comment" is of course optional.
7485
7486
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007487 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007488 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007489 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007490 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007491
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007492 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007493 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007494 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007495
7496 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7497 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007498 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007499 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007500 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007501 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007502 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007503 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007504 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7505 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007506 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007507 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7508 tcp-check expect string +OK
7509
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007510 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007511 (send many headers before analyzing)
7512 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007513 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007514 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7515 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7516 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7517 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007518 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007519
7520
7521 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7522
7523
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007524option tcp-smart-accept
7525no option tcp-smart-accept
7526 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7528 yes | yes | yes | no
7529 Arguments : none
7530
7531 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7532 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7533 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7534 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7535 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7536 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7537
7538 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7539 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7540 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7541 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7542
7543 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7544 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7545 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007546 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007547
7548 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7549 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7550 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7551
7552 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7553 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7554 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7555
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007556 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7557
7558
7559option tcp-smart-connect
7560no option tcp-smart-connect
7561 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7563 yes | no | yes | yes
7564 Arguments : none
7565
7566 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7567 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7568 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7569 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7570 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7571
7572 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7573 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7574 complex.
7575
7576 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7577 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7578 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7579
7580 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7581 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7582
7583 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7584
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007585
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007586option tcpka
7587 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7589 yes | yes | yes | yes
7590 Arguments : none
7591
7592 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7593 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007594 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007595 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7596
7597 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7598 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7599 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7600 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7601
7602 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7603 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7604 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7605 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7606 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7607
7608 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7609
7610 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7611 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7612 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7613 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7614 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7615 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7616 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7617 backends.
7618
7619 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7620
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007621
7622option tcplog
7623 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007625 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007626 Arguments : none
7627
7628 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7629 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7630 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7631 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7632 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7633 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7634 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7635 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7636
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007637 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7638
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007639 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007640
7641
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007642option transparent
7643no option transparent
7644 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7645 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007646 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007647 Arguments : none
7648
7649 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7650 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7651 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7652 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7653 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7654 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7655 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7656 appropriate server.
7657
7658 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7659 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7660
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007661 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007662 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007663
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007664
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007665external-check command <command>
7666 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7668 yes | no | yes | yes
7669
7670 Arguments :
7671 <command> is the external command to run
7672
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007673 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7674
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007675 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007676
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007677 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7678 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7679 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7680 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7681 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7682 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007683
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007684 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7685
7686 Environment variables :
7687 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7688 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7689
7690 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7691
7692 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7693
7694 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7695 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7696 for a UNIX socket).
7697
7698 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7699
7700 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7701
7702 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7703
7704 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7705
7706 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7707
7708 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7709 socket).
7710
7711 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7712 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7713
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02007714 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
7715
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007716 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7717 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7718 failed.
7719
7720 Example :
7721 external-check command /bin/true
7722
7723 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7724
7725
7726external-check path <path>
7727 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7729 yes | no | yes | yes
7730
7731 Arguments :
7732 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7733
7734 The default path is "".
7735
7736 Example :
7737 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7738
7739 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7740 "external-check command"
7741
7742
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007743persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007744persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007745 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7747 yes | no | yes | yes
7748 Arguments :
7749 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007750 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7751 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007752
7753 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7754 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007755 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007756 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7757 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7758 forwarded to this server.
7759
7760 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7761 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7762 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007763 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007764 a single "listen" section.
7765
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007766 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7767 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7768 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7769
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007770 Example :
7771 listen tse-farm
7772 bind :3389
7773 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7774 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7775 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7776 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7777 persist rdp-cookie
7778 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007779 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007780 balance rdp-cookie
7781 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7782 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7783
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007784 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7785 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007786
7787
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007788rate-limit sessions <rate>
7789 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7790 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7791 yes | yes | yes | no
7792 Arguments :
7793 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7794 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7795
7796 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7797 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7798 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7799 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7800 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7801 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7802
7803 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7804 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7805 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7806 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7807
7808 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7809 listen smtp
7810 mode tcp
7811 bind :25
7812 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007813 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007814
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007815 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7816 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7817 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007818
7819 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7820
7821
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007822redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7823redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7824redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007825 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7827 no | yes | yes | yes
7828
7829 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007830 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007831
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007832 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007833 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007834 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7835 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7836 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007837
7838 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7839 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7840 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7841 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7842 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007843 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7844 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7845 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7846 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007847
7848 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7849 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7850 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7851 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7852 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7853 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007854 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007855 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007856 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7857 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7858 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007859
7860 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007861 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7862 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7863 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007864 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007865 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7866 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7867 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7868 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007869
7870 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007871 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007872
7873 - "drop-query"
7874 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7875 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7876 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7877 with a location-type redirect.
7878
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007879 - "append-slash"
7880 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7881 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7882 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7883 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7884
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007885 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7886 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7887 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7888 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7889 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7890 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7891 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7892
7893 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7894 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7895 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7896 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7897 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7898 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7899 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007900
7901 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7902 acl clear dst_port 80
7903 acl secure dst_port 8080
7904 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007905 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007906 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007907 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7908
7909 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007910 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7911 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7912 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007913 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007914
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007915 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7916 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7917 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7918
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007919 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007920 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007921
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007922 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007923 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7924 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7925 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007926
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007927 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007928
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007929
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007930retries <value>
7931 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7932 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7933 yes | no | yes | yes
7934 Arguments :
7935 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7936 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7937 default value is 3.
7938
7939 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7940 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7941 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7942
7943 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007944 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7945 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007946
7947 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7948 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7949
7950 See also : "option redispatch"
7951
7952
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007953retry-on [list of keywords]
7954 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
7955 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7956 yes | no | yes | yes
7957 Arguments :
7958 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
7959 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
7960 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
7961 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
7962
7963 none never retry
7964
7965 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
7966 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
7967
7968 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
7969 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
7970 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
7971 request timeout on the server side, poor network
7972 condition, or a server crash or restart while
7973 processing the request.
7974
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02007975 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
7976 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
7977 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
7978 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
7979 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
7980 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
7981 overflow attack for example).
7982
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007983 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
7984 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
7985 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
7986 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
7987 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
7988 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
7989 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
7990 amplify denial of service attacks.
7991
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02007992 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
7993 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
7994 considered to be safe to retry.
7995
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007996 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
7997 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
7998 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
7999 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8000
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008001 all-retryable-errors
8002 retry request for any error that are considered
8003 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8004 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8005 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8006
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008007 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8008 not cumulative.
8009
8010 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8011 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8012 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8013 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8014
8015 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8016 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8017 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8018 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8019 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8020 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8021 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8022 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8023 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8024 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8025 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8026 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8027
8028 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8029 should not use this directive.
8030
8031 The default is "conn-failure".
8032
8033 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8034
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008035server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008036 Declare a server in a backend
8037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8038 no | no | yes | yes
8039 Arguments :
8040 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008041 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008042 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008043
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008044 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8045 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8046 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8047 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008048 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8049 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8050 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8051 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8052 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008053 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8054 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8055 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8056 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8057 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8058 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8059 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008060 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008061 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8062 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8063 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8064 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8065 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8066 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008067 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8068 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008069 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8070 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008071
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008072 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008073 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8074 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8075 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8076 adding this value to the client's port.
8077
8078 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8079 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008080 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008081
8082 Examples :
8083 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8084 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008085 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008086 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8087 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8088 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008089
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008090 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8091 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8092 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8093 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8094 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8095
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008096 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8097 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008098
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008099server-state-file-name [<file>]
8100 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8101 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8102 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8103 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8104 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8105 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8106
8107 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8108 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8109
8110 global
8111 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8112
8113 backend bk
8114 load-server-state-from-file
8115
8116 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8117 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008118
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008119server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8120 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8121 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8123 no | no | yes | yes
8124
8125 Arguments:
8126 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8127
8128 <num | range>
8129 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8130 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8131 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8132 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8133
8134 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8135
8136 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8137
8138 <params*>
8139 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8140 keyword.
8141
8142 Examples:
8143 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8144 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8145 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8146
8147 # or
8148 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8149
8150 # would be equivalent to:
8151 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8152 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8153 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8154
8155
8156
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008157source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008158source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008159source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008160 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8162 yes | no | yes | yes
8163 Arguments :
8164 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8165 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008166
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008167 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008168 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8169 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8170 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8171 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8172 supported prefixes are :
8173 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8174 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8175 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008176 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008177 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8178 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008179
8180 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8181 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008182 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8183 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8184 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008185
8186 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8187 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8188 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8189 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8190 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8191 <addr>.
8192
8193 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8194 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8195 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8196 port.
8197
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008198 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8199 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8200 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8201 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008202 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008203 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8204 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8205 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8206 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8207 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8208 HTTP header.
8209
8210 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8211 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008212 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008213 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8214 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8215 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8216 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8217 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8218 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8219 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8220
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008221 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8222 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8223 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8224 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8225 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8226 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8227
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008228 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8229 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8230 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8231 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8232
8233 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8234 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8235 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8236 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8237 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8238 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8239
8240 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8241 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8242 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8243 there are two methods :
8244
8245 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8246 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8247 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8248 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8249 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8250 of the client ranges may be used.
8251
8252 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8253 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8254 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8255 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8256 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8257 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8258 same session.
8259
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008260 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8261 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8262 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008263 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008264
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008265 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8266
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008267 Examples :
8268 backend private
8269 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8270 source 192.168.1.200
8271
8272 backend transparent_ssl1
8273 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8274 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8275
8276 backend transparent_ssl2
8277 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8278 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8279 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8280
8281 backend transparent_ssl3
8282 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8283 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8284 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8285
8286 backend transparent_smtp
8287 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8288 # with Tproxy version 4.
8289 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8290
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008291 backend transparent_http
8292 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8293 # proxy.
8294 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8295
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008296 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008297 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8298
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008299
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008300stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8301 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8302 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008303 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008304
8305 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8306 matched.
8307
8308 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8309 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8310
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008311 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8312 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008313 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008314
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008315 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8316 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8317 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8318 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008319
8320 Example :
8321 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8322 backend stats_localhost
8323 stats enable
8324 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8325
8326 Example :
8327 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8328 backend stats_auth
8329 stats enable
8330 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8331 stats admin if TRUE
8332
8333 Example :
8334 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8335 userlist stats-auth
8336 group admin users admin
8337 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8338 group readonly users haproxy
8339 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8340
8341 backend stats_auth
8342 stats enable
8343 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8344 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8345 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8346 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8347
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008348 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8349 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8350 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008351
8352
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008353stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8354 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008356 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008357 Arguments :
8358 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8359
8360 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8361
8362 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8363 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8364 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8365 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8366 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8367 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8368
8369 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8370 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8371 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008372 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008373
8374 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8375 report using "stats scope".
8376
8377 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8378 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8379 unobvious parameters.
8380
8381 Example :
8382 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8383 backend public_www
8384 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8385 stats enable
8386 stats hide-version
8387 stats scope .
8388 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008389 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008390 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8391 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8392
8393 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8394 backend private_monitoring
8395 stats enable
8396 stats uri /admin?stats
8397 stats refresh 5s
8398
8399 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8400
8401
8402stats enable
8403 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008405 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008406 Arguments : none
8407
8408 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8409 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8410 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8411 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8412 - stats auth : no authentication
8413 - stats scope : no restriction
8414
8415 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8416 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8417 unobvious parameters.
8418
8419 Example :
8420 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8421 backend public_www
8422 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8423 stats enable
8424 stats hide-version
8425 stats scope .
8426 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008427 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008428 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8429 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8430
8431 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8432 backend private_monitoring
8433 stats enable
8434 stats uri /admin?stats
8435 stats refresh 5s
8436
8437 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8438
8439
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008440stats hide-version
8441 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008443 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008444 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008445
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008446 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8447 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8448 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8449 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8450 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8451 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008452
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008453 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8454 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8455 unobvious parameters.
8456
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008457 Example :
8458 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8459 backend public_www
8460 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008461 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008462 stats hide-version
8463 stats scope .
8464 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008465 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008466 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8467 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008468
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008469 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8470 backend private_monitoring
8471 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008472 stats uri /admin?stats
8473 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008474
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008475 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008476
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008477
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008478stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8479 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8480 Access control for statistics
8481
8482 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8483 no | no | yes | yes
8484
8485 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8486 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8487 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8488 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8489 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8490 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8491
8492 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8493 instance.
8494
8495 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8496 about ACL usage.
8497
8498
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008499stats realm <realm>
8500 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008502 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008503 Arguments :
8504 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8505 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8506 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8507
8508 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8509 using a backslash ('\').
8510
8511 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8512 only related to authentication.
8513
8514 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8515 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8516 unobvious parameters.
8517
8518 Example :
8519 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8520 backend public_www
8521 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8522 stats enable
8523 stats hide-version
8524 stats scope .
8525 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008526 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008527 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8528 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8529
8530 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8531 backend private_monitoring
8532 stats enable
8533 stats uri /admin?stats
8534 stats refresh 5s
8535
8536 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8537
8538
8539stats refresh <delay>
8540 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008542 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008543 Arguments :
8544 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8545 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8546 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8547 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8548 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8549 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8550
8551 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8552 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8553 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8554 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8555
8556 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8557 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8558 unobvious parameters.
8559
8560 Example :
8561 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8562 backend public_www
8563 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8564 stats enable
8565 stats hide-version
8566 stats scope .
8567 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008568 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008569 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8570 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8571
8572 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8573 backend private_monitoring
8574 stats enable
8575 stats uri /admin?stats
8576 stats refresh 5s
8577
8578 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8579
8580
8581stats scope { <name> | "." }
8582 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008584 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008585 Arguments :
8586 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8587 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8588 section in which the statement appears.
8589
8590 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8591 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8592 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8593 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8594 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8595 exists.
8596
8597 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8598 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8599 unobvious parameters.
8600
8601 Example :
8602 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8603 backend public_www
8604 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8605 stats enable
8606 stats hide-version
8607 stats scope .
8608 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008609 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008610 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8611 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8612
8613 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8614 backend private_monitoring
8615 stats enable
8616 stats uri /admin?stats
8617 stats refresh 5s
8618
8619 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8620
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008621
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008622stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008623 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008625 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008626
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008627 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008628 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8629
8630 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8631 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8632
8633 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8634 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008635 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008636
8637 Example :
8638 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8639 backend private_monitoring
8640 stats enable
8641 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8642 stats uri /admin?stats
8643 stats refresh 5s
8644
8645 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8646 global section.
8647
8648
8649stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008650 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8652 yes | yes | yes | yes
8653 Arguments : none
8654
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008655 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008656 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8657 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8658 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8659 - IP (socket, server)
8660 - cookie (backend, server)
8661
8662 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8663 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008664 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008665
8666 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8667
8668
8669stats show-node [ <name> ]
8670 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008672 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008673 Arguments:
8674 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8675 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8676
8677 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8678 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008679 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008680
8681 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8682 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8683 unobvious parameters.
8684
8685 Example:
8686 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8687 backend private_monitoring
8688 stats enable
8689 stats show-node Europe-1
8690 stats uri /admin?stats
8691 stats refresh 5s
8692
8693 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8694 section.
8695
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008696
8697stats uri <prefix>
8698 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008700 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008701 Arguments :
8702 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8703 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8704 query string.
8705
8706 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8707 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8708 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8709 possible to reach it in the application.
8710
8711 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008712 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008713 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8714 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8715 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8716 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8717
8718 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8719 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8720 an address or a port to statistics only.
8721
8722 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8723 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8724 unobvious parameters.
8725
8726 Example :
8727 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8728 backend public_www
8729 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8730 stats enable
8731 stats hide-version
8732 stats scope .
8733 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008734 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008735 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8736 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8737
8738 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8739 backend private_monitoring
8740 stats enable
8741 stats uri /admin?stats
8742 stats refresh 5s
8743
8744 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8745
8746
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008747stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8748 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008750 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008751
8752 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008753 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008754 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008755 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008756 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8757
8758 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8759 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8760 the "stick-table" statement.
8761
8762 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8763 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8764 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8765 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8766 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8767
8768 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8769 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8770 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8771 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8772 transformation rules.
8773
8774 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8775 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8776 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8777 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8778 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8779 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8780 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8781
8782 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8783 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8784 ACL based conditions.
8785
8786 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8787 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8788 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8789 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8790
8791 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8792 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8793 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8794 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8795
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008796 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8797 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008798 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008799
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008800 Example :
8801 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8802 # last 30 minutes
8803 backend pop
8804 mode tcp
8805 balance roundrobin
8806 stick store-request src
8807 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8808 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8809 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8810
8811 backend smtp
8812 mode tcp
8813 balance roundrobin
8814 stick match src table pop
8815 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8816 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8817
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008818 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008819 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008820
8821
8822stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8823 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8825 no | no | yes | yes
8826
8827 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8828 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8829 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8830 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8831
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008832 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8833 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008834 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008835
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008836 Examples :
8837 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008838 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008839
8840 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8841 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8842 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8843
8844
8845 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8846 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8847 backend http
8848 mode http
8849 balance roundrobin
8850 stick on src table https
8851 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8852 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8853 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8854
8855 backend https
8856 mode tcp
8857 balance roundrobin
8858 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8859 stick on src
8860 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8861 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8862
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008863 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008864
8865
8866stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8867 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8869 no | no | yes | yes
8870
8871 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008872 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008873 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008874 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008875 server is selected.
8876
8877 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8878 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8879 the "stick-table" statement.
8880
8881 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8882 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8883 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8884 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8885 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8886 address.
8887
8888 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8889 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8890 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8891 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8892 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8893 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8894 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8895 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8896 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8897 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8898
8899 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8900 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8901 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8902 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8903 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8904 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8905 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8906
8907 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8908 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8909 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8910 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8911
8912 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8913 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8914 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8915 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8916 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8917 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008918 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8919 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8920 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8921 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8922 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8923 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008924
8925 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8926 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8927 the request.
8928
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008929 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8930 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008931 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008932
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008933 Example :
8934 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8935 # last 30 minutes
8936 backend pop
8937 mode tcp
8938 balance roundrobin
8939 stick store-request src
8940 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8941 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8942 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8943
8944 backend smtp
8945 mode tcp
8946 balance roundrobin
8947 stick match src table pop
8948 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8949 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8950
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008951 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008952 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008953
8954
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008955stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008956 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8957 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008958 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008960 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008961
8962 Arguments :
8963 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8964 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8965 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8966 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8967
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008968 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8969 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8970 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8971 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8972
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008973 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8974 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8975 instance.
8976
8977 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8978 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8979 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8980 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8981 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8982 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008983 to 32 characters.
8984
8985 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8986 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8987 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008988 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008989 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8990 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008991
8992 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008993 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8994 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008995 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8996 increase.
8997
8998 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008999 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9000 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9001 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009002
9003 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9004 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9005 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9006 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009007 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009008 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9009 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9010 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9011 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9012 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9013 parameter (see below).
9014
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009015 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9016 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9017 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9018 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9019 soft restart.
9020
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009021 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9022 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009023
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009024 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9025 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9026 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9027 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009028 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009029 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009030 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9031 if not expiration delay is specified.
9032
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009033 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9034 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9035 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9036 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009037 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9038 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9039 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9040 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9041 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9042 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9043 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9044 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9045 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9046 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9047 types and their arguments.
9048
9049 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9050 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9051 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9052 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9053
9054 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9055 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9056 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009057 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009058
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009059 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9060 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9061 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009062 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009063 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009064 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009065
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009066 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9067 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9068 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9069 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9070
9071 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9072 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9073 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9074 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9075 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9076 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9077
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009078 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9079 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9080 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9081 they were received.
9082
9083 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9084 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9085 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9086 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9087 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9088
9089 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9090 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9091 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9092 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9093 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9094
9095 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9096 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9097 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9098
9099 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9100 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9101 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9102 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9103 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9104
9105 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9106 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9107 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9108 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9109 the client side.
9110
9111 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9112 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9113 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9114 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9115 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9116 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9117 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9118
9119 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9120 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9121 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9122 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9123 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9124 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009125 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009126
9127 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9128 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9129 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9130 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9131 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9132 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9133
9134 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009135 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009136 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9137 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9138
9139 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9140 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9141 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9142 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9143 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9144 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9145 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9146 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9147 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9148 recommended for better fairness.
9149
9150 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009151 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009152 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9153 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9154
9155 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9156 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9157 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9158 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9159 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9160 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9161 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9162 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9163 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9164 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009165
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009166 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9167 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009168 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9169 reference it.
9170
9171 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9172 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009173 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9174 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9175 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009176
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009177 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9178 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9179 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9180 something that can be ignored.
9181
9182 Example:
9183 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9184 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9185 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9186 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9187
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009188 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009189 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009190
9191
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009192stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009193 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9195 no | no | yes | yes
9196
9197 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009198 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009199 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009200 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009201 server is selected.
9202
9203 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9204 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9205 the "stick-table" statement.
9206
9207 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9208 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9209 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9210 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9211
9212 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9213 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9214 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9215 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9216 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9217 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009218 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009219 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9220 rules.
9221
9222 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9223 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9224 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9225 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9226 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9227 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9228 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9229
9230 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9231 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9232 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9233 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9234
9235 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9236 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9237 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9238 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9239 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9240 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009241 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9242 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9243 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9244 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9245 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9246 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9247 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9248 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9249 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009250
9251 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9252
9253 Example :
9254 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9255 backend https
9256 mode tcp
9257 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009258 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009259 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009260
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009261 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9262 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9263
9264 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9265 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9266 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9267
9268 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9269 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009270
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009271 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9272 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9273 # at offset 44.
9274
9275 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9276 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9277
9278 # Learn on response if server hello.
9279 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009280
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009281 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9282 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9283
9284 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9285 extraction.
9286
9287
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009288tcp-check connect [params*]
9289 Opens a new connection
9290 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9291 no | no | yes | yes
9292
9293 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9294 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9295 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9296
9297 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9298 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9299 of the sequence.
9300
9301 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9302 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9303 do.
9304
9305 Parameters :
9306 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9307 use the TCP connection.
9308
9309 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9310 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9311 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9312
9313 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9314
9315 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9316
9317 Examples:
9318 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9319 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9320 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9321 option tcp-check
9322 tcp-check connect
9323 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9324 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9325 tcp-check send \r\n
9326 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9327 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9328 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9329 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9330 tcp-check send \r\n
9331 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9332 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9333
9334 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9335 option tcp-check
9336 tcp-check connect port 110
9337 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9338 tcp-check connect port 143
9339 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9340 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9341
9342 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9343
9344
9345tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009346 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009347 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9348 no | no | yes | yes
9349
9350 Arguments :
9351 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9352 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9353 binary.
9354 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9355 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9356 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9357
9358 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9359 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9360 with the usual backslash ('\').
9361 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009362 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009363 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9364 used upper or lower case.
9365
9366
9367 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9368
9369 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9370 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9371 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9372 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9373 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9374 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9375 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9376 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9377
9378 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9379 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9380 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9381 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9382 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9383 expression.
9384
9385 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9386 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9387 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9388 this exact hexadecimal string.
9389 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9390
9391 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9392 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9393 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9394 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9395 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9396 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9397 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9398 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9399 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9400 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9401 the null character.
9402
9403 Examples :
9404 # perform a POP check
9405 option tcp-check
9406 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9407
9408 # perform an IMAP check
9409 option tcp-check
9410 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9411
9412 # look for the redis master server
9413 option tcp-check
9414 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009415 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009416 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9417 tcp-check expect string role:master
9418 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9419 tcp-check expect string +OK
9420
9421
9422 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9423 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9424
9425
9426tcp-check send <data>
9427 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9428 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9429 no | no | yes | yes
9430
9431 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9432 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9433
9434 Examples :
9435 # look for the redis master server
9436 option tcp-check
9437 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9438 tcp-check expect string role:master
9439
9440 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9441 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9442
9443
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009444tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9445 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009446 tcp health check
9447 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9448 no | no | yes | yes
9449
9450 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9451 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009452 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009453 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9454 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9455 hexadecimal string.
9456 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9457
9458 Examples :
9459 # redis check in binary
9460 option tcp-check
9461 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9462 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9463
9464
9465 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9466 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9467
9468
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009469tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9470 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9472 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009473 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009474 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9475 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009476
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009477 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009478
9479 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9480 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009481 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9482 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9483 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9484 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9485 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9486 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009487
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009488 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9489 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9490 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9491 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009492
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009493 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009494 - accept :
9495 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9496 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9497 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009498
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009499 - reject :
9500 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9501 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9502 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9503 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9504 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9505 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9506 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9507 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9508 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9509 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9510 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009511 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009512
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009513 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9514 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9515 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9516 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9517 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9518 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9519 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9520 hosts.
9521
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009522 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9523 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9524 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9525 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9526 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9527 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9528 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9529 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9530
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009531 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9532 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9533 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9534 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9535 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9536 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9537 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9538 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9539 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009540 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9541 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009542
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009543 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009544 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009545 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9546 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9547 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05009548 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009549 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9550 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9551 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9552 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9553 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9554 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9555 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9556 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009557
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009558 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009559 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009560 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009561 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009562 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9563 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9564 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009565
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009566 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9567 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9568 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9569 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009570
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009571 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9572 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9573 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9574 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9575 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009576 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9577 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9578 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9579 layer7 information is extracted.
9580
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009581 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9582 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9583 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9584 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9585 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009586
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009587 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9588 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9589 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9590 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9591
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009592 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9593 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9594 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9595 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9596
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01009597 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
9598 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
9599 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
9600 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
9601 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009602
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009603 - set-src <expr> :
9604 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9605 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9606 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009607 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009608
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009609 Arguments:
9610 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9611 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009612
9613 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009614 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9615
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009616 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9617 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009618
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009619 - set-src-port <expr> :
9620 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9621 expression.
9622
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009623 Arguments:
9624 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9625 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009626
9627 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009628 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9629
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009630 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9631 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9632 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009633
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009634 - set-dst <expr> :
9635 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9636 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9637 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9638 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9639 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9640
9641 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9642 followed by some converters.
9643
9644 Example:
9645
9646 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9647 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9648
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009649 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9650 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9651
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009652 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9653 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9654 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9655 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9656
9657
9658 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9659 followed by some converters.
9660
9661 Example:
9662
9663 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9664
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009665 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9666 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9667 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9668
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009669 - "silent-drop" :
9670 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009671 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009672 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9673 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9674 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9675 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9676 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009677 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9678 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009679 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9680 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009681 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009682 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9683 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9684 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9685 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9686
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009687 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9688 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9689 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009690
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009691 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9692 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9693 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009694
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009695 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009696 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009697 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009698
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009699 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9700 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9701 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009702
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009703 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009704 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9705 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009706
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009707 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9708
9709 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9710
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009711 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9712
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009713 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009714
9715
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009716tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9717 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009719 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009720 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009721 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9722 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009723
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009724 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009725
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009726 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009727 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9728 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9729 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9730 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009731
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009732 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9733 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9734 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9735 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009736 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9737 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9738 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9739 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9740 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9741 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009742 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009743 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009744
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009745 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9746 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9747 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9748 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009749
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009750 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009751 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009752 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009753 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9754 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009755 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009756 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009757 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009758 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01009759 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009760 - set-dst <expr>
9761 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009762 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009763 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009764 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009765 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01009766 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009767
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009768 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9769 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009770 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
9771 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009772
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009773 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9774 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9775 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9776 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9777 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9778 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009779
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009780 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009781 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9782 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009783
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009784 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009785 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9786 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9787 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9788 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009789 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9790 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9791 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009792
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009793 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009794 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9795 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9796 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009797
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009798 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
9799 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
9800
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009801 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009802 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9803 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009804
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009805 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9806 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009807 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009808 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9809 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009810 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009811 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009812 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009813 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9814 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009815 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009816 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9817 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009818
9819 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9820 followed by some converters.
9821
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009822 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9823 <var-name>.
9824
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009825 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9826 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9827 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9828 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9829 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
9830
9831 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
9832 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
9833 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
9834 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
9835 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
9836 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
9837 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
9838 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
9839 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
9840 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
9841 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
9842
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009843 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9844 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9845 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9846 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9847 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9848
9849 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9850
9851 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9852
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01009853 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
9854 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
9855 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
9856 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
9857 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
9858 evaluated.
9859
9860 Example:
9861 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
9862
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009863 Example:
9864
9865 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009866 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009867
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009868 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009869 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9870 # and reject everything else.
9871 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9872 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009873 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009874 tcp-request content reject
9875
9876 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009877 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9878 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9879 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009880 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009881
9882 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9883 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9884 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009885 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009886 tcp-request content reject
9887
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009888 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009889 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009890 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009891 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009892 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9893 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009894
9895 Example:
9896 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9897 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009898 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009899
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009900 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009901 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009902
9903 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009904 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009905 # protecting all our sites
9906 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009907 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9908 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009909 ...
9910 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9911
9912 backend http_dynamic
9913 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009914 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009915 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009916 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009917 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009918 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009919 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009920
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009921 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009922
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009923 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9924 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009925
9926
9927tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9928 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9929 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009930 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009931 Arguments :
9932 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9933 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9934 as explained at the top of this document.
9935
9936 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9937 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9938 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9939 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9940 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9941
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009942 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9943 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9944 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9945 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9946
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009947 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9948 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009949 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009950 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009951 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9952 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9953 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9954 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009955
9956 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9957 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9958 it pass through unaffected.
9959
9960 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9961 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9962 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009963 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009964 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9965 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009966 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9967 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9968 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009969
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009970 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009971 "timeout client".
9972
9973
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009974tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9975 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9977 no | no | yes | yes
9978 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009979 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9980 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009981
9982 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9983
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009984 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009985 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9986 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009987 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9988 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009989
9990 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9991
9992 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9993 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9994 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9995 inserted.
9996
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009997 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009998 - accept :
9999 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10000 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10001 the rules evaluation.
10002
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010003 - close :
10004 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10005 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10006 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10007 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10008 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10009 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010010 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010011 protocols.
10012
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010013 - reject :
10014 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10015 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010016 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010017
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010018 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10019 Sets a variable.
10020
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010021 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10022 Unsets a variable.
10023
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010024 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10025 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10026 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10027 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10028
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010029 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10030 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10031 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10032 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10033
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010034 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
10035 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10036 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10037 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10038 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010039
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010040 - "silent-drop" :
10041 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010042 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010043 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10044 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10045 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10046 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10047 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010048 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10049 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010050 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10051 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010052 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010053 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10054 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10055 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10056 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10057
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010058 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10059 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10060
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010061 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10062 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10063 for changing the default action to a reject.
10064
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010065 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10066 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10067 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10068 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010069 period.
10070
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010071 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10072 declared inline.
10073
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010074 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10075 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010076 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010077 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10078 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010079 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010080 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010081 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010082 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10083 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010084 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010085 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10086 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010087
10088 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10089 followed by some converters.
10090
10091 Example:
10092
10093 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10094
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010095 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10096 <var-name>.
10097
10098 Example:
10099
10100 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10101
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010102 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10103 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10104 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10105 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10106 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10107
10108 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10109
10110 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10111
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010112 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10113
10114 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10115
10116
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010117tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10118 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10120 no | yes | yes | no
10121 Arguments :
10122 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10123 below.
10124
10125 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10126
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010127 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010128 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10129 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10130 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10131 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10132 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10133 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10134 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010135 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010136 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10137 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10138 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10139 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10140 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10141 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10142 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10143 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10144 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10145 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10146 instead.
10147
10148 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10149 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10150 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10151 rules which may be inserted.
10152
10153 Several types of actions are supported :
10154 - accept : the request is accepted
10155 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10156 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10157 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010158 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010159 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010160 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010161 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010162 - silent-drop
10163
10164 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10165 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10166 sections for a complete description.
10167
10168 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10169 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10170 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10171
10172 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10173 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10174 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10175 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10176 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10177
10178 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10179 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10180
10181 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10182 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10183 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10184
10185 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10186 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10187 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10188
10189 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10190 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10191 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10192
10193 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10194 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10195 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10196
10197 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10198
10199 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10200
10201
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010202tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10203 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10204 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10205 no | no | yes | yes
10206 Arguments :
10207 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10208 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10209 as explained at the top of this document.
10210
10211 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10212
10213
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010214timeout check <timeout>
10215 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10216 established.
10217
10218 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10219 yes | no | yes | yes
10220 Arguments:
10221 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10222 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10223 as explained at the top of this document.
10224
10225 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10226 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010227 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010228 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010229 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10230 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10231 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010232
10233 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10234 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10235
10236 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10237 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010238 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010239
10240 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10241 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10242 forget about it.
10243
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010244 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10245 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010246
10247
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010248timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010249 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10250 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10251 yes | yes | yes | no
10252 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010253 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010254 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10255 as explained at the top of this document.
10256
10257 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10258 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10259 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010260 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10261 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10262 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10263 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010264 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10265 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10266 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010267 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010268 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010269 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10270 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010271 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10272 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010273
10274 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10275 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10276 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10277 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010278 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010279 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10280
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010281 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010282
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010283 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010284
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010285
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010286timeout client-fin <timeout>
10287 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10289 yes | yes | yes | no
10290 Arguments :
10291 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10292 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10293 as explained at the top of this document.
10294
10295 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10296 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10297 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10298 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10299 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10300 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10301 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010302 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10303 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10304 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010305
10306 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10307 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10308 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10309
10310 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10311
10312
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010313timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010314 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10315 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10316 yes | no | yes | yes
10317 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010318 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010319 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10320 as explained at the top of this document.
10321
10322 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010323 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010324 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010325 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010326 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10327 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010328
10329 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10330 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10331 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10332 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010333 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010334 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10335
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010336 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010337
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010338
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010339timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10340 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10341 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10342 yes | yes | yes | yes
10343 Arguments :
10344 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10345 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10346 as explained at the top of this document.
10347
10348 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10349 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10350 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10351 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10352 once the request has started to present itself.
10353
10354 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10355 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10356 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10357 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10358 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10359
10360 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10361 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10362 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10363 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10364
10365 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10366 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010367 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010368 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10369 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010370 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010371
10372 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10373 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10374 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10375 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10376
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010377 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10378 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010379 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10380
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010381 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10382
10383
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010384timeout http-request <timeout>
10385 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010387 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010388 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010389 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010390 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10391 as explained at the top of this document.
10392
10393 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10394 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10395 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10396 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10397 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10398 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10399 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010400 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10401 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10402 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10403 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010404 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010405 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10406 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010407
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010408 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10409 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10410 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10411 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10412 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010413 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010414
10415 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10416 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010417 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010418 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10419 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10420
10421 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010422 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10423 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10424 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010425
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010426 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010427 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010428
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010429
10430timeout queue <timeout>
10431 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10433 yes | no | yes | yes
10434 Arguments :
10435 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10436 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10437 as explained at the top of this document.
10438
10439 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10440 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10441 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10442 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10443 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10444
10445 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10446 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10447 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10448 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10449
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010450 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010451
10452
10453timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010454 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10456 yes | no | yes | yes
10457 Arguments :
10458 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10459 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10460 as explained at the top of this document.
10461
10462 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10463 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10464 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10465 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10466 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10467 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10468 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10469
10470 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10471 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10472 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10473 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10474 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010475 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010476 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010477 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10478 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010479 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10480 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010481
10482 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10483 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10484 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10485 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010486 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010487 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10488
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010489 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010490
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010491
10492timeout server-fin <timeout>
10493 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10495 yes | no | yes | yes
10496 Arguments :
10497 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10498 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10499 as explained at the top of this document.
10500
10501 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10502 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10503 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10504 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10505 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10506 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10507 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10508 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10509 situations, it should not be needed.
10510
10511 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10512 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10513 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10514
10515 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10516
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010517
10518timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010519 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10521 yes | yes | yes | yes
10522 Arguments :
10523 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10524 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10525 as explained at the top of this document.
10526
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020010527 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
10528 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
10529 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010530
10531 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10532 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10533 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10534 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010535 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010536
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010537 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010538
10539
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010540timeout tunnel <timeout>
10541 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10543 yes | no | yes | yes
10544 Arguments :
10545 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10546 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10547 as explained at the top of this document.
10548
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010549 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010550 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10551 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10552 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010553 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10554 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010555 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10556 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10557 specified.
10558
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010559 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10560 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10561 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10562 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10563 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10564 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10565 state.
10566
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010567 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10568 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10569 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10570 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010571 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010572
10573 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10574 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10575 forget about it.
10576
10577 Example :
10578 defaults http
10579 option http-server-close
10580 timeout connect 5s
10581 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010582 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010583 timeout server 30s
10584 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10585
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010586 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010587
10588
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010589transparent (deprecated)
10590 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010592 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010593 Arguments : none
10594
10595 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10596 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10597 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10598 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10599 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10600 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10601 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10602 appropriate server.
10603
10604 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10605
10606 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10607 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10608
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010609 See also: "option transparent"
10610
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010611unique-id-format <string>
10612 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10614 yes | yes | yes | no
10615 Arguments :
10616 <string> is a log-format string.
10617
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010618 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10619 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10620 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10621 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010622
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010623 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10624 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10625 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10626 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10627 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10628 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10629 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10630 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010631
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010632 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10633 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010634
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010635 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010636
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010637 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010638
10639 will generate:
10640
10641 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10642
10643 See also: "unique-id-header"
10644
10645unique-id-header <name>
10646 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10648 yes | yes | yes | no
10649 Arguments :
10650 <name> is the name of the header.
10651
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010652 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10653 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010654
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010655 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010656
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010657 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010658 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10659
10660 will generate:
10661
10662 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10663
10664 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010665
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010666use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010667 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010668 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10669 no | yes | yes | no
10670 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010671 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10672 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010673
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010674 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10675 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010676
10677 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10678 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10679 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010680 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010681 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010682 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10683 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010684
10685 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10686 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10687 assign the backend.
10688
10689 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10690 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10691 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10692 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10693 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10694 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10695
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010696 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010697 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010698 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10699 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10700 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10701
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010702 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10703 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10704 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10705 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10706 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10707 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10708 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10709 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10710 cannot be forced from the request.
10711
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010712 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010713 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10714 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10715
10716 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10717 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010718
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020010719use-fcgi-app <name>
10720 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
10721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10722 no | no | yes | yes
10723 Arguments :
10724 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
10725
10726 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010727
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010728use-server <server> if <condition>
10729use-server <server> unless <condition>
10730 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10732 no | no | yes | yes
10733 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010734 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010735
10736 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10737
10738 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10739 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10740 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10741
10742 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10743 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10744 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10745 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10746 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10747 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10748 matches will assign the server.
10749
10750 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10751 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10752 with the next rules until one matches.
10753
10754 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10755 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10756 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10757 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10758
10759 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10760 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10761 stripped.
10762
10763 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10764 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10765 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10766 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10767
10768 Example :
10769 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10770 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10771 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10772 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10773 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10774 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010775 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010776 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10777 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10778
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010779 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010780
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010781
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100107825. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010783--------------------------
10784
10785The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10786depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10787settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10788written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10789described in this section.
10790
10791
107925.1. Bind options
10793-----------------
10794
10795The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10796as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10797no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10798parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10799while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10800provided immediately after the setting name.
10801
10802The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10803
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010804accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10805 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10806 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10807 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10808 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10809 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10810 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10811 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10812 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10813 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010814 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10815 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10816 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010817
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010818accept-proxy
10819 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010820 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10821 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010822 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10823 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10824 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10825 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010826 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010827 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10828 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010829 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10830 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010831
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010832allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010010833 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010834 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010835 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010836 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
10837 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010838
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010839alpn <protocols>
10840 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10841 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10842 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010843 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010844 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010845 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10846 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10847 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10848 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10849 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10850 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10851 preference, like below :
10852
10853 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010854
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010855backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010010856 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010857 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10858
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010859curves <curves>
10860 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10861 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10862 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10863 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10864 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10865 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10866
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010867ecdhe <named curve>
10868 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010869 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10870 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010871
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010872ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010873 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10874 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10875 client's certificate.
10876
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010877ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10878 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10879 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10880 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10881 error is ignored.
10882
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010883ca-sign-file <cafile>
10884 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10885 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10886 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10887 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10888 'generate-certificates' for details.
10889
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010890ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010891 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10892 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10893 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10894 'generate-certificates' for details.
10895
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010896ciphers <ciphers>
10897 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10898 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000010899 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010900 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020010901 information and recommendations see e.g.
10902 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
10903 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
10904 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
10905
10906ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
10907 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
10908 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
10909 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
10910 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010911 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
10912 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010913
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010914crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010915 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10916 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10917 to verify client's certificate.
10918
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010919crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010920 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10921 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10922 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10923 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10924 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10925 file.
10926
10927 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10928 are loaded.
10929
10930 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010931 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010932 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10933 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10934 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10935 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010936 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10937 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010938 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010939
10940 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10941 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10942 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10943 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010944 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10945 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010946
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010947 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010948
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010949 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010950 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010951 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
10952 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010953 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10954 clients).
10955
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010956 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10957 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10958 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10959 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10960 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10961 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10962 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10963 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10964 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10965 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10966 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10967 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10968 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10969
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010970 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10971 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10972 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10973 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10974 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10975
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010976 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10977 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10978 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10979 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010980
10981 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10982 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10983 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10984 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10985 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10986 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10987 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10988 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10989 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10990
10991 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10992
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010993 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010994 a cert bundle.
10995
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010996 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010997 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10998 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10999 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11000 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11001 provide multi-cert support.
11002
11003 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11004
11005 Filename | CN | SAN
11006 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11007 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011008 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011009 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11010 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11011
11012 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11013 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11014 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11015 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011016 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11017 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11018 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011019
11020 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11021 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11022
11023 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11024 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11025 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11026
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011027crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011028 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011029 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011030 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011031 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011032
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011033crt-list <file>
11034 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011035 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11036 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011037
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011038 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11039
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011040 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11041 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011042 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011043 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011044
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011045 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11046 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11047 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11048 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11049 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11050 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11051 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11052 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011053
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011054 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011055 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011056 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11057 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11058 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011059
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011060 crt-list file example:
11061 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011062 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011063 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011064 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011065
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011066defer-accept
11067 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11068 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11069 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011070 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011071 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11072 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11073 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11074 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11075 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11076 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11077 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11078
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011079expose-fd listeners
11080 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11081 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011082 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11083 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011084 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011085
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011086force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011087 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011088 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011089 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011090 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011091
11092force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011093 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011094 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011095 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011096
11097force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011098 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011099 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011100 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011101
11102force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011103 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011104 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011105 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011106
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011107force-tlsv13
11108 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11109 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011110 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011111
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011112generate-certificates
11113 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11114 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11115 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11116 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11117 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11118 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11119 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11120 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11121 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11122 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11123 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11124
11125 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11126 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011127 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011128 certificate is used many times.
11129
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011130gid <gid>
11131 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11132 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11133 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11134 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11135 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11136
11137group <group>
11138 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11139 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11140 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11141 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11142 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11143
11144id <id>
11145 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11146 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11147 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11148 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11149
11150interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011151 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11152 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11153 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11154 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11155 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11156 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011157 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11158 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11159 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11160 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11161 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11162 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011163
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011164level <level>
11165 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11166 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11167 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011168 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011169 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11170 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11171 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011172 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011173 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011174 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011175 all counters).
11176
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011177severity-output <format>
11178 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11179 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11180 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11181 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11182 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11183 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11184 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11185 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11186 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11187 rfc5424 convention.
11188
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011189maxconn <maxconn>
11190 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11191 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11192 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11193 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11194 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11195 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11196 eat all memory.
11197
11198mode <mode>
11199 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11200 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11201 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11202 UNIX sockets.
11203
11204mss <maxseg>
11205 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11206 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11207 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11208 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11209 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11210 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11211 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11212 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11213 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11214 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11215 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11216
11217name <name>
11218 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11219 page.
11220
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011221namespace <name>
11222 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11223 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11224 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11225 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11226
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011227nice <nice>
11228 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11229 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11230 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11231 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11232 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11233 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11234 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11235 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11236 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11237 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11238 one for an RDP socket.
11239
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011240no-ca-names
11241 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11242 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11243
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011244no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011245 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011246 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011247 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011248 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011249 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11250 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011251
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011252no-tls-tickets
11253 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11254 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11255 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011256 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11257 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011258
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011259no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011260 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011261 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011262 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011263 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011264 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11265 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011266
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011267no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011268 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011269 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011270 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011271 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011272 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11273 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011274
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011275no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011276 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011277 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011278 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011279 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011280 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11281 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011282
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011283no-tlsv13
11284 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11285 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11286 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11287 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011288 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11289 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011290
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011291npn <protocols>
11292 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11293 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11294 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011295 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011296 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011297 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11298 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11299 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11300 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11301 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011302
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011303prefer-client-ciphers
11304 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11305 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11306 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011307 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11308 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11309 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011310
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011311process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011312 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011313 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011314 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011315 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11316 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11317 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11318 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011319 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011320 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11321 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11322 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11323 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11324 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011325
11326 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11327
11328 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11329 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11330 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11331 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11332 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11333 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11334 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11335 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011336
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011337proto <name>
11338 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11339 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11340 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11341 in haproxy -vv.
11342 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11343 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011344 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011345 h2" on the bind line.
11346
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011347ssl
11348 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011349 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011350 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11351 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011352 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11353 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011354
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011355ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11356 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11357 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11358 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11359
11360ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11361 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11362 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11363 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11364
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011365strict-sni
11366 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11367 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11368 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11369 See the "crt" option for more information.
11370
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011371tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011372 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011373 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11374 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011375 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011376 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11377 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11378 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11379 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11380 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11381 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11382 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11383
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011384tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011385 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011386 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11387 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11388 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11389 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11390 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11391 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11392 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011393 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11394 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11395 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011396
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011397tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11398 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011399 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11400 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11401 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11402 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11403 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11404 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11405 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11406 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11407 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11408 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011409 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11410 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11411
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011412transparent
11413 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11414 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11415 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11416 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11417 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11418 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11419 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11420 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11421 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11422 so check for support with your vendor.
11423
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011424v4v6
11425 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11426 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11427 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11428 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011429 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011430
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011431v6only
11432 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11433 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11434 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011435 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11436 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011437
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011438uid <uid>
11439 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11440 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11441 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11442 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11443 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11444
11445user <user>
11446 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11447 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11448 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11449 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11450 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11451
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011452verify [none|optional|required]
11453 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11454 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11455 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11456 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11457 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011458 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11459 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11460 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11461 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011462
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200114635.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011464------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011465
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011466The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11467which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11468arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11469settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11470after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11471Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11472address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011473
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011474 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011475 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011476
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011477Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11478keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11479
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011480The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011481
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011482addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011483 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011484 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11485 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11486 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11487 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11488 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011489
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011490agent-check
11491 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011492 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011493 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11494 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11495 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011496
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011497 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011498 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011499 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11500 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11501 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011502
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011503 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11504 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11505 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11506 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11507 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011508
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011509 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011510 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011511
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011512 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11513 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11514 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011515
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011516 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11517 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11518 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011519
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011520 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11521 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11522 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11523 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11524 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011525 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011526 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011527
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011528 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11529 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011530
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011531 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11532 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11533 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11534 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11535 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11536 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11537 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11538 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11539 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011540
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011541 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11542 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011543 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11544 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11545 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011546 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011547
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011548 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011549 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011550
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011551agent-send <string>
11552 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11553 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11554 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11555 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11556 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11557
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011558agent-inter <delay>
11559 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11560 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11561
11562 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11563 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11564 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11565 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11566 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11567 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11568 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11569 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11570 of backends use the same servers.
11571
11572 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11573
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011574agent-addr <addr>
11575 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11576
11577 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11578 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11579 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11580 hostname, it will be resolved.
11581
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011582agent-port <port>
11583 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11584
11585 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11586
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011587allow-0rtt
11588 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020011589 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
11590 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011591
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011592alpn <protocols>
11593 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11594 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11595 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011596 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011597 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11598 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11599 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11600 now obsolete NPN extension.
11601 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11602 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11603
11604 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11605
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011606backup
11607 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11608 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11609 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11610 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011611 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11612 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011613
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011614ca-file <cafile>
11615 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11616 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11617 server's certificate.
11618
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011619check
11620 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011621 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11622 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11623 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11624 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11625 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11626 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11627 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011628 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11629 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011630 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11631 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011632
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011633check-send-proxy
11634 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11635 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11636 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11637 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11638 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11639 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11640 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11641
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011642check-alpn <protocols>
11643 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11644 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11645 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11646
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011647check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011648 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011649 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11650 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011651
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011652check-ssl
11653 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11654 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11655 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11656 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011657 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011658 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11659 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011660 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011661 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11662 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011663
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011664check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011665 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011666 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
11667 for normal traffic.
11668
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011669ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011670 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11671 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11672 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011673 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
11674 information and recommendations see e.g.
11675 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11676 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11677 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011678
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011679ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11680 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11681 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11682 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11683 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011684 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
11685 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
11686 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011687
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011688cookie <value>
11689 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11690 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11691 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11692 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11693 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11694 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11695 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11696
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011697crl-file <crlfile>
11698 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11699 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11700 to verify server's certificate.
11701
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011702crt <cert>
11703 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11704 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11705 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11706 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11707 certificate request.
11708
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011709disabled
11710 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11711 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11712 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11713 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11714 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011715 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011716
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011717enabled
11718 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11719 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11720 default value.
11721 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11722 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011723
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011724error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011725 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11726 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11727 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011728
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011729 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011730
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011731fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011732 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11733 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11734 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11735
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011736force-sslv3
11737 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11738 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011739 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011740 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011741
11742force-tlsv10
11743 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011744 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011745 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011746
11747force-tlsv11
11748 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011749 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011750 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011751
11752force-tlsv12
11753 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011754 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011755 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011756
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011757force-tlsv13
11758 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11759 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011760 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011761
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011762id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011763 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11764 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11765 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011766
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011767init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11768 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11769 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011770 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011771 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11772 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11773 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11774 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11775 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11776 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11777 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11778 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11779 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011780 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011781 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11782 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11783 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11784 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11785 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11786 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011787 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011788
11789 Example:
11790 defaults
11791 # never fail on address resolution
11792 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11793
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011794inter <delay>
11795fastinter <delay>
11796downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011797 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11798 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11799 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11800 between checks depending on the server state :
11801
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011802 Server state | Interval used
11803 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11804 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11805 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11806 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11807 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11808 or yet unchecked. |
11809 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11810 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11811 | "inter" otherwise.
11812 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011813
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011814 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11815 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11816 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11817 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011818 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11819 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11820 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11821 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11822 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011823
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011824maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011825 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11826 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010011827 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
11828 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011829 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11830 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11831 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11832 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11833
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010011834 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
11835 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
11836 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
11837 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
11838 than 50 concurrent requests.
11839
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011840maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011841 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11842 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11843 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11844 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11845 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11846 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11847 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11848
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010011849max-reuse <count>
11850 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
11851 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
11852 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
11853 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
11854 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
11855 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
11856 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
11857 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
11858
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011859minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011860 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11861 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11862 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11863 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11864 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11865 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011866 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011867 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011868
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011869namespace <name>
11870 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11871 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11872 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11873 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11874
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011875no-agent-check
11876 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11877 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11878 default value.
11879 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11880 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11881
11882no-backup
11883 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11884 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11885 default value.
11886 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11887 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11888
11889no-check
11890 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11891 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11892 default value.
11893 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11894 "default-server" "check" setting.
11895
11896no-check-ssl
11897 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11898 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11899 default value.
11900 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11901 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11902
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011903no-send-proxy
11904 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11905 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11906 default value.
11907 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11908 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11909
11910no-send-proxy-v2
11911 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11912 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11913 default value.
11914 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11915 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11916
11917no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11918 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11919 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11920 default value.
11921 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11922 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11923
11924no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11925 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11926 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11927 default value.
11928 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11929 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11930
11931no-ssl
11932 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11933 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11934 default value.
11935 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11936 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11937
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011938no-ssl-reuse
11939 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11940 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11941 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11942 and for paranoid users.
11943
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011944no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011945 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11946 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011947 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011948
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011949 Supported in default-server: No
11950
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011951no-tls-tickets
11952 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11953 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11954 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011955 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11956 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011957 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011958
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011959no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011960 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011961 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11962 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011963 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11964 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011965 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011966
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011967 Supported in default-server: No
11968
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011969no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011970 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011971 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11972 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011973 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11974 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011975 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011976
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011977 Supported in default-server: No
11978
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011979no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011980 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011981 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11982 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011983 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11984 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011985 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011986
11987 Supported in default-server: No
11988
11989no-tlsv13
11990 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11991 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11992 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11993 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11994 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011995 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011996
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011997 Supported in default-server: No
11998
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011999no-verifyhost
12000 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12001 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12002 default value.
12003 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12004 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012005
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012006no-tfo
12007 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
12008 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12009 default value.
12010 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12011 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
12012
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012013non-stick
12014 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12015 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12016 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12017
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012018npn <protocols>
12019 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12020 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12021 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012022 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012023 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12024 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12025 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12026
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012027observe <mode>
12028 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12029 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12030 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12031 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12032 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12033 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012034 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012035
12036 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12037
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012038on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012039 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12040 Currently, four modes are available:
12041 - fastinter: force fastinter
12042 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12043 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12044 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12045 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12046
12047 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12048
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012049on-marked-down <action>
12050 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12051 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012052 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12053 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12054 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12055 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12056 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12057 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12058 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12059 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012060
12061 Actions are disabled by default
12062
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012063on-marked-up <action>
12064 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12065 Currently one action is available:
12066 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12067 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12068 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12069 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012070 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12071 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012072 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12073 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12074
12075 Actions are disabled by default
12076
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012077pool-max-conn <max>
12078 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12079 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12080 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12081 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12082 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12083 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12084
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012085pool-purge-delay <delay>
12086 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012087 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020012088 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012089
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012090port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012091 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12092 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12093 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12094 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12095 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12096 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12097
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012098proto <name>
12099
12100 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12101 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12102 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12103 reported in haproxy -vv.
12104 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12105 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12106
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012107redir <prefix>
12108 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12109 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12110 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12111 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12112 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12113 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12114 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12115 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012116 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012117 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012118 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12119 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12120 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12121 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12122
12123 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12124
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012125rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012126 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12127 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12128 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12129
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012130resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12131 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12132 server.
12133
12134 Available options:
12135
12136 * allow-dup-ip
12137 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12138 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12139 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12140 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12141 For such case, simply enable this option.
12142 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12143
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050012144 * ignore-weight
12145 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
12146 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
12147 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
12148
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012149 * prevent-dup-ip
12150 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12151 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12152 same fqdn.
12153 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12154
12155 Example:
12156 backend b_myapp
12157 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12158 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12159 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12160
12161 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12162 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12163 it
12164 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12165 different address
12166
12167 Default value: not set
12168
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012169resolve-prefer <family>
12170 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12171 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12172 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12173 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12174
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012175 Default value: ipv6
12176
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012177 Example:
12178
12179 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012180
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012181resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012182 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012183 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012184 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012185 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12186 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012187 configured network, another address is selected.
12188
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012189 Example:
12190
12191 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012192
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012193resolvers <id>
12194 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12195 hostname.
12196
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012197 Example:
12198
12199 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012200
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012201 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012202
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012203send-proxy
12204 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12205 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12206 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12207 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012208 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12209 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12210 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12211 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12212 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12213 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12214 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12215 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12216 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12217 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012218 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12219 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012220
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012221send-proxy-v2
12222 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12223 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12224 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12225 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012226 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12227 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12228 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12229 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012230
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012231proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12232 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12233 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012234 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12235 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012236 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12237 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012238 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012239
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012240send-proxy-v2-ssl
12241 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12242 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12243 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12244 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12245 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12246 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12247 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012248 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12249 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012250
12251send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12252 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12253 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12254 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12255 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12256 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12257 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12258 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12259 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012260 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12261 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012262
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012263slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012264 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12265 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12266 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12267 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12268 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12269 parameters :
12270
12271 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12272 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12273
12274 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12275 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12276 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12277 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12278
12279 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12280 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12281 seen as failed.
12282
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012283sni <expression>
12284 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12285 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12286 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12287 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012288 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12289 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012290 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012291 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12292 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012293
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012294source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012295source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012296source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012297 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12298 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12299 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12300 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12301
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012302 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12303 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12304 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12305 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12306 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12307 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12308 server.
12309
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012310 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12311 specifying the source address without port(s).
12312
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012313ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012314 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12315 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12316 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12317 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12318 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12319 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012320 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12321 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012322
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012323ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12324 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12325 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12326 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12327
12328ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12329 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12330 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12331 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12332
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012333ssl-reuse
12334 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12335 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12336 default value.
12337 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12338 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12339
12340stick
12341 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12342 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12343 default value.
12344 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12345 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012346
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012347socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012348 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012349 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12350 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12351
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012352tcp-ut <delay>
12353 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12354 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12355 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012356 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012357 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12358 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12359 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12360 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12361 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12362 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12363 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12364 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12365 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12366
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012367tfo
12368 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12369 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12370 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12371 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12372 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012373 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012374
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012375track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012376 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12377 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12378 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12379 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012380 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12381
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012382tls-tickets
12383 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12384 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12385 default value.
12386 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12387 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012388
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012389verify [none|required]
12390 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012391 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012392 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12393 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012394 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012395 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12396 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12397 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12398 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12399 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12400 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12401 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12402 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012403
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012404verifyhost <hostname>
12405 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012406 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12407 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12408 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12409 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12410 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12411 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12412 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12413 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012414
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012415weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012416 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12417 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12418 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012419 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12420 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12421 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12422 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12423 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12424 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012425
12426
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200124275.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12428-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012429
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012430HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12431using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12432configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012433This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12434can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12435workload.
12436This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12437resolution at run time.
12438Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12439carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12440
12441
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200124425.3.1. Global overview
12443----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012444
12445As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12446different steps of the process life:
12447
12448 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12449 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12450 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12451
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012452 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12453 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012454
12455A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12456 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12457 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12458 resolution to know this new IP.
12459
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012460When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012461HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012462SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12463from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12464will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12465will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012466
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012467A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012468 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012469 first valid response.
12470
12471 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12472 servers return an error.
12473
12474
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200124755.3.2. The resolvers section
12476----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012477
12478This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012479HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12480contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012481
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012482When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12483uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12484is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12485answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12486
12487When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012488used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012489
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012490 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12491 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12492 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012493
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012494 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12495 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012496
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012497 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12498 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12499 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012500
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012501For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12502following scenarios are possible:
12503
12504 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12505 ignored
12506
12507 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12508 applied
12509
12510 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12511 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12512
12513 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12514 retries the query with a new type
12515
12516 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12517 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012518
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012519As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12520a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012521<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012522
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012523
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012524resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012525 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012526
12527A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12528
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012529accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012530 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012531 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012532 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12533 by RFC 6891)
12534
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012535 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12536
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012537nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12538 DNS server description:
12539 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12540 <ip> : IP address of the server
12541 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12542
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012543parse-resolv-conf
12544 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12545 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12546 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12547
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012548hold <status> <period>
12549 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12550 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012551 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012552 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012553 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12554 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12555 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12556
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012557 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012558
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012559resolve_retries <nb>
12560 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12561 giving up.
12562 Default value: 3
12563
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012564 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12565 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12566 type.
12567
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012568timeout <event> <time>
12569 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12570 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12571 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012572 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12573 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012574 Default value: 1s
12575 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012576 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012577 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012578 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12579 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12580
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012581 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012582
12583 resolvers mydns
12584 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12585 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012586 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012587 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012588 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012589 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012590 hold other 30s
12591 hold refused 30s
12592 hold nx 30s
12593 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012594 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012595 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012596
12597
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200125986. Cache
12599---------
12600
12601HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
12602(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
12603RAM.
12604
12605The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
12606this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
12607
12608If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
12609independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
12610when we try to allocate a new one.
12611
12612The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
12613
12614It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
12615"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
12616for more details.
12617
12618When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
12619replaced by "<CACHE>".
12620
12621
126226.1. Limitation
12623----------------
12624
12625The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
12626
12627- If the response is not a 200
12628- If the response contains a Vary header
12629- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
12630- If the response is not cacheable
12631
12632- If the request is not a GET
12633- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
12634- If the request contains an Authorization header
12635
12636
126376.2. Setup
12638-----------
12639
12640To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
12641the corresponding http-request and response actions.
12642
12643
126446.2.1. Cache section
12645---------------------
12646
12647cache <name>
12648 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
12649 size of cache is mandatory.
12650
12651total-max-size <megabytes>
12652 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
12653 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
12654
12655max-object-size <bytes>
12656 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
12657 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
12658 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
12659
12660max-age <seconds>
12661 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
12662 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
12663 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
12664 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
12665 default.
12666
12667
126686.2.2. Proxy section
12669---------------------
12670
12671http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12672 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
12673 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
12674 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
12675 after this one.
12676
12677http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12678 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
12679 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
12680 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
12681 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
12682
12683
12684Example:
12685
12686 backend bck1
12687 mode http
12688
12689 http-request cache-use foobar
12690 http-response cache-store foobar
12691 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
12692
12693 cache foobar
12694 total-max-size 4
12695 max-age 240
12696
12697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200126987. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12699----------------------------------
12700
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012701HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012702client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12703The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12704these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12705but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12706data called patterns.
12707
12708
127097.1. ACL basics
12710---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012711
12712The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12713content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12714from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12715simple :
12716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012717 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012718 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012719 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12720 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012722The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12723adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012724
12725In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012727 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012728
12729This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12730Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12731and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012732an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12733conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12734as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12735are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012736
12737ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12738'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12739which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12740
12741There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12742performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012744The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12745specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12746this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012747methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12748ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012749
12750Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12751 - boolean
12752 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12753 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12754 - string
12755 - data block
12756
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012757Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12758converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12759would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12760The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12761which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12762
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012763Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12764keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12765fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12766which are summarized in the table below :
12767
12768 +---------------------+-----------------+
12769 | Sample or converter | Default |
12770 | output type | matching method |
12771 +---------------------+-----------------+
12772 | boolean | bool |
12773 +---------------------+-----------------+
12774 | integer | int |
12775 +---------------------+-----------------+
12776 | ip | ip |
12777 +---------------------+-----------------+
12778 | string | str |
12779 +---------------------+-----------------+
12780 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12781 +---------------------+-----------------+
12782
12783Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12784matching method, see below.
12785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012786The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12787 - boolean
12788 - integer or integer range
12789 - IP address / network
12790 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12791 - regular expression
12792 - hex block
12793
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012794The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12795
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012796 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12797 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012798 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012799 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012800 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012801 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012802 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012804The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12805read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12806if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12807lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12808will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12809beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12810a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12811lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12812exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12813
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012814The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12815parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12816ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12817a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12818check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12819
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012820The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12821socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12822file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12823
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012824Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12825loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12826
12827 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12828
12829In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12830the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12831case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12832as well.
12833
12834The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12835sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12836do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12837methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12838is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012839obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012840followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12841default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12842that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12843string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12844
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012845The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12846By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12847string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12848resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12849server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012850waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012851flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12852function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012854There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12855sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12856be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012857
12858 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12859 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012860 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12861 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12862 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12863 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012864
12865 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12866 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012867 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012868
12869 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012870 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012871
12872 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012873 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012874
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012875 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012876 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12877
12878 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12879 binary or string samples.
12880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012881 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12882 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012884 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12885 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12886 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012888 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12889 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012891 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12892 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012894 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12895 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012897 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12898 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012899 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12900
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012901 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12902 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12903 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012904
12905For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12906request, it is possible to do :
12907
12908 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12909
12910In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12911buffer, one would use the following acl :
12912
12913 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12914
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012915On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12916possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12917
12918 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012920All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12921criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12922method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12923to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12924criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12925the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012927If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012928the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12929For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012931 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12932 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12933 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12934 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012935
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012936
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012937The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12938types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12939combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12940brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12941default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012943 +-------------------------------------------------+
12944 | Input sample type |
12945 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012946 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012947 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12948 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12949 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012950 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012951 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012952 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012953 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012954 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012955 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012956 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012957 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012958 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012959 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012960 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012961 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012962 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012963 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012964 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012965 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012966 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012967 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012968 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012969 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012970 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012971 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12972 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12973 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012974
12975
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129767.1.1. Matching booleans
12977------------------------
12978
12979In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12980Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12981When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12982that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12983
12984Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12985return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12986"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12987
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129897.1.2. Matching integers
12990------------------------
12991
12992Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12993enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12994to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12995
12996Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12997matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12998lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012999
13000For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13001unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13002representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13003
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013004As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13005two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13006instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13007ranges and operators.
13008
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013009For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013010operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13011Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13012of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013013
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013014Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013015
13016 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13017 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13018 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13019 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13020 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13021
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013022For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013023
13024 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13025
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013026This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13027
13028 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13029
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130317.1.3. Matching strings
13032-----------------------
13033
13034String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13035different forms :
13036
13037 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013038 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013039
13040 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013041 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013042
13043 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13044 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13045
13046 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13047 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13048
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013049 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013050 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13051 matches.
13052
13053 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13054 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13055 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013056
13057String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13058exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13059characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13060string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13061to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013062before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013063
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010013064Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
13065(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
13066Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
13067
13068Example:
13069 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
13070 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
13071
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13074---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013075
13076Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13077they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13078possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13079passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13080the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013081the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13082match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013083
13084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130857.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13086-------------------------------------
13087
13088It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13089not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13090a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13091to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13092digits may be used upper or lower case.
13093
13094Example :
13095 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13096 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13097
13098
130997.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13100---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013101
13102IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13103netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13104within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013105host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013106difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13107at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13108does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13109parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013110
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013111The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13112abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13113
13114 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13115 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13116 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13117 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13118 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13119 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13120 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13121 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13122
13123Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13124192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13125
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013126IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13127Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13128trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13129IPv6 patterns.
13130
13131HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13132following situations :
13133 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13134 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13135 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13136 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13137 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13138 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13139 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13140 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13141 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13142 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013144
131457.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13146----------------------------------
13147
13148Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13149combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13150
13151 - AND (implicit)
13152 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13153 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013155A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013157 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013159Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13160indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013162For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13163"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13164requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13165is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13166
13167 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013168 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13169 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13170 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013171
13172To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13173and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13174
13175 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13176 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13177 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13178 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13179
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013180 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013181 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13182 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13183 use_backend www if host_www
13184
13185It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13186expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13187be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13188the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13189
13190 The following rule :
13191
13192 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013193 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013194
13195 Can also be written that way :
13196
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013197 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013198
13199It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13200to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13201simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13202sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13203good use is the following :
13204
13205 With named ACLs :
13206
13207 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13208 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13209 monitor fail if site_dead
13210
13211 With anonymous ACLs :
13212
13213 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13214
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013215See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13216keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013217
13218
132197.3. Fetching samples
13220---------------------
13221
13222Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13223against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13224sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13225ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13226of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13227available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13228
13229This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13230Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13231compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13232deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13233
13234The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13235matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13236method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13237indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13238
13239As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13240when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13241mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13242the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13243ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13244
13245Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13246multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13247when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013248incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13249are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013250is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13251all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13252
13253Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13254 - name
13255 - name(arg1)
13256 - name(arg1,arg2)
13257
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013258
132597.3.1. Converters
13260-----------------
13261
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013262Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13263of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13264is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13265was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013266has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013267unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13268
13269These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13270sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13271the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013272support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013273
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013274A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13275support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13276supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13277(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13278bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013280The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013281
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001328251d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13283 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13284 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13285 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13286 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13287 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13288
13289 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013290 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13291 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013292 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13293 frontend http-in
13294 bind *:8081
13295 default_backend servers
13296 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13297 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13298
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013299add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013300 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013301 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013302 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13303 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013304 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013305 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13306 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13307 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13308 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013309 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013310 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013311
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013312aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13313 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13314 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13315 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13316 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13317 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13318 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13319
13320 Example:
13321 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13322 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13323
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013324and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013325 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013326 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013327 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13328 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013329 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013330 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13331 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13332 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13333 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013334 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013335 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013336
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013337b64dec
13338 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13339 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13340
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013341base64
13342 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013343 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013344 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13345
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013346bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013347 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013348 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013349 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013350 presence of a flag).
13351
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013352bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13353 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13354 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013355 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013356
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013357concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13358 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13359 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13360 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13361 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13362 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13363 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13364 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13365 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13366 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13367 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013368 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. Note that due to the config
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013369 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013370 delimiters.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013371
13372 Example:
13373 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13374 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13375 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13376 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13377
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013378cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013379 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13380 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013381
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013382crc32([<avalanche>])
13383 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13384 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13385 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13386 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13387 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13388 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13389 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13390 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13391 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13392 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013393 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13394
13395crc32c([<avalanche>])
13396 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13397 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13398 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13399 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13400 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13401 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13402 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13403 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013404
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013405da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013406 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13407 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13408 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13409 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013410 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013411 configuration language.
13412
13413 Example:
13414 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013415 bind *:8881
13416 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013417 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013418
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010013419debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
13420 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
13421 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
13422 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
13423 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
13424 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
13425 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
13426 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
13427 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
13428 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
13429 printable sample types.
13430
13431 Example:
13432 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013433
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013434div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013435 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13436 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013437 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013438 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13439 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013440 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013441 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13442 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13443 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13444 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013445 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013446 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013447
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013448djb2([<avalanche>])
13449 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13450 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13451 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13452 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13453 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13454 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13455 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013456 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13457 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013458
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013459even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013460 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013461 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13462
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013463field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13464 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13465 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13466 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13467 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13468 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13469 fields.
13470
13471 Example :
13472 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13473 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13474 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13475 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13476 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013477
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013478hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013479 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013480 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013481 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013482 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013483
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013484hex2i
13485 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013486 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013487
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010013488http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013489 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13490 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000013491 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
13492 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
13493 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
13494 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
13495 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
13496 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
13497 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
13498 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013499
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013500in_table(<table>)
13501 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13502 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13503 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013504 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013505 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13506
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013507ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13508 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013509 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013510 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13511 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13512 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13513 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13514 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013515
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013516json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013517 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013518 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013519 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013520 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13521 of errors:
13522 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13523 bytes, ...)
13524 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13525 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13526
13527 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13528 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13529 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13530 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13531 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13532 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013533 - "ascii" : never fails;
13534 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13535 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013536 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013537 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013538 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13539 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13540
13541 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013542 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013543
13544 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013545 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013546 capture request header user-agent len 150
13547 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013548
13549 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13550 GET / HTTP/1.0
13551 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13552
13553 Output log:
13554 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13555
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013556language(<value>[,<default>])
13557 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13558 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13559 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13560 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13561 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13562 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13563 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13564 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13565 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013566 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013567 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13568 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013569
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013570 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013571
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013572 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13573 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013574
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013575 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13576 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13577 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13578 use_backend spanish if es
13579 use_backend french if fr
13580 use_backend english if en
13581 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013582
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013583length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013584 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13585 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13586 type. The result is of type integer.
13587
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013588lower
13589 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13590 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13591 type. The result is of type string.
13592
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013593ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13594 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13595 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13596 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13597 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13598 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13599 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13600
13601 Example :
13602
13603 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013604 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013605 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13606
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013607map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13608map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13609map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13610 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13611 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13612 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13613 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13614 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13615 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13616 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13617 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013618
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013619 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13620 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13621 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013622
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013623 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013624 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013625
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013626 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13627 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13628 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13629 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013630 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13631 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013632 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13633 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13634 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13635 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13636 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13637 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13638 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13639 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013640 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13641 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13642 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013643 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13644 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13645 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13646 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13647 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013648
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013649 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13650 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13651 the corresponding match text.
13652
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013653 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13654 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13655 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13656 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13657 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013658
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013659 Example :
13660
13661 # this is a comment and is ignored
13662 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13663 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13664 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13665 | | | `---------- value
13666 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13667 | `---------------------------- key
13668 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13669
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013670mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013671 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13672 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013673 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013674 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013675 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013676 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13677 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13678 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13679 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013680 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013681 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013682
13683mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013684 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013685 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13686 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013687 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013688 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013689 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013690 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13691 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13692 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13693 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013694 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013695 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013696
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013697nbsrv
13698 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13699 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13700 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13701 map lookup.
13702
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013703neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013704 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13705 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13706 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13707 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013708
13709not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013710 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013711 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013712 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013713 absence of a flag).
13714
13715odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013716 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013717 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13718
13719or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013720 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013721 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013722 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13723 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013724 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013725 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13726 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13727 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13728 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013729 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013730 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013731
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013732protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
13733 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
13734 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
13735 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
13736 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
13737 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13738 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13739 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13740 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
13741 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
13742 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13743 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
13744
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013745regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013746 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13747 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13748 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13749 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13750 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13751 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13752 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13753 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13754 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13755 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013756 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13757 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13758 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13759 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013760
13761 Example :
13762
13763 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13764 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13765 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13766 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13767
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013768capture-req(<id>)
13769 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13770 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13771
13772 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013773 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13774 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013775
13776capture-res(<id>)
13777 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13778 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13779
13780 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013781 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13782 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013783
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013784sdbm([<avalanche>])
13785 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13786 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13787 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13788 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13789 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13790 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13791 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013792 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13793 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013794
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013795set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013796 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13797 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13798 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013799 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013800 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13801 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013802 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013803 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13804 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013805 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013806 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013807
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013808sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020013809 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013810 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13811
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020013812sha2([<bits>])
13813 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
13814 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
13815
13816 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
13817 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
13818
13819 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
13820 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
13821
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020013822srv_queue
13823 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
13824 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
13825 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
13826 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
13827 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
13828
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013829strcmp(<var>)
13830 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13831 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13832 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13833 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13834 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13835 shorter).
13836
13837 Example :
13838
13839 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13840 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13841 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13842
13843
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013844sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013845 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13846 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013847 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013848 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13849 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013850 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013851 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13852 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013853 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013854 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13855 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013856 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013857 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013858
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013859table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13860 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13861 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13862 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13863 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13864 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13865 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13866
13867
13868table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13869 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13870 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13871 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13872 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13873 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13874 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13875
13876table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13877 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13878 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013879 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013880 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13881 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13882
13883table_conn_cur(<table>)
13884 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13885 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13886 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13887 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13888 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13889
13890table_conn_rate(<table>)
13891 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13892 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13893 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13894 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13895 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13896
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013897table_gpt0(<table>)
13898 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13899 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13900 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13901 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13902 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13903
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013904table_gpc0(<table>)
13905 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13906 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13907 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13908 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13909 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13910
13911table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13912 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13913 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13914 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13915 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13916 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13917 sample fetch keyword.
13918
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013919table_gpc1(<table>)
13920 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13921 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13922 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
13923 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13924 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
13925
13926table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
13927 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13928 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13929 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
13930 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13931 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
13932 sample fetch keyword.
13933
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013934table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13935 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13936 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013937 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013938 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13939 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13940
13941table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13942 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13943 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13944 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13945 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13946 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13947 keyword.
13948
13949table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13950 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13951 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013952 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013953 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13954 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13955
13956table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13957 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13958 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13959 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13960 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13961 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13962 keyword.
13963
13964table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13965 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13966 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013967 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013968 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13969 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13970 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13971 keyword.
13972
13973table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13974 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13975 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013976 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013977 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13978 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13979 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13980 keyword.
13981
13982table_server_id(<table>)
13983 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13984 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13985 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13986 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13987 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13988 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13989
13990table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13991 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13992 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013993 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013994 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13995 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13996 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13997 keyword.
13998
13999table_sess_rate(<table>)
14000 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14001 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14002 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14003 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14004 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14005 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14006 keyword.
14007
14008table_trackers(<table>)
14009 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14010 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14011 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14012 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14013 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14014 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14015 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14016 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14017 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14018 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14019
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014020upper
14021 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14022 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14023 type. The result is of type string.
14024
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014025url_dec
14026 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
14027 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
14028
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014029ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014030 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014031 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14032 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14033 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014034 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14035 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14036 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14037 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014038 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014039 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14040 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014041
14042 Example:
14043 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14044 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14045
14046 message Point {
14047 int32 latitude = 1;
14048 int32 longitude = 2;
14049 }
14050
14051 message PPoint {
14052 Point point = 59;
14053 }
14054
14055 message Rectangle {
14056 // One corner of the rectangle.
14057 PPoint lo = 48;
14058 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14059 PPoint hi = 49;
14060 }
14061
14062 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14063 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14064 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14065
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014066 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14067 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014068 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014069 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14070
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014071 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014072
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014073 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014074
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014075 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014076 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14077 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14078
14079 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14080 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14081 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14082
14083 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14084 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14085 interpret the previous binary sample.
14086
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014087
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014088unset-var(<var name>)
14089 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14090 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14091 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14092 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14093 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14094 response),
14095 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14096 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14097 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14098 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14099
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014100utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14101 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14102 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14103 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14104 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14105 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14106 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14107
14108 Example :
14109
14110 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014111 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014112 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14113
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014114word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14115 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14116 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14117 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
14118 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14119 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14120
14121 Example :
14122 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14123 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14124 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14125 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14126 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014127
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014128wt6([<avalanche>])
14129 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14130 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14131 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14132 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14133 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14134 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14135 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014136 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14137 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014138
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014139xor(<value>)
14140 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014141 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014142 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014143 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014144 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014145 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14146 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014147 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014148 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14149 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014150 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014151 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014152
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014153xxh32([<seed>])
14154 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14155 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14156 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14157 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14158 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14159 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14160 as cryptographically secure.
14161
14162xxh64([<seed>])
14163 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14164 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14165 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14166 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14167 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14168 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14169 as cryptographically secure.
14170
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014171
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200141727.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014173--------------------------------------------
14174
14175A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14176not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14177"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14178The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14179
14180always_false : boolean
14181 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14182 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14183
14184always_true : boolean
14185 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14186 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14187
14188avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014189 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014190 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14191 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14192 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14193 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14194 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14195 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14196 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14197 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14198 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14199 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14200 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14201 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14202 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014204be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014205 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14206 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14207 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14208 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014209 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14210
14211be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14212 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14213 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14214 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14215 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14216 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014217 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14218 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014219
14220 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14221 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14222 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014224be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14225 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14226 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14227 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014228 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014229 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14230 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014231
14232 Example :
14233 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14234 backend dynamic
14235 mode http
14236 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14237 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014238
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014239bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014240 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14241 of the string.
14242
14243bool(<bool>) : bool
14244 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14245 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014247connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14248 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014249 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014250 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14251 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014252
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014253 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014254 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014255 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14256
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014257 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14258 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014259
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014260 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014261 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014262 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014263 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014264 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014265 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014266 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014267
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014268 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14269 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014270 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014271 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014272
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014273cpu_calls : integer
14274 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14275 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14276 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14277 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14278 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14279 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14280
14281cpu_ns_avg : integer
14282 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14283 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14284 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14285 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14286 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14287 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14288 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14289 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14290 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14291 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14292 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14293
14294cpu_ns_tot : integer
14295 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14296 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14297 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14298 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14299 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14300 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14301 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14302 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14303 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14304 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14305 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14306 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14307 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14308
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014309date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014310 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014311
14312 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
14313 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
14314 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014315 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14316
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014317 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
14318 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
14319 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
14320 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
14321 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
14322
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014323 Example :
14324
14325 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14326 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014327
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014328 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
14329 # millisecond granularity
14330 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
14331
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014332date_us : integer
14333 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14334 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14335 from the same timeval structure.
14336
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014337distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14338 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14339 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14340 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14341 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14342 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14343 list of supported tokens.
14344
14345distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14346 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14347 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14348 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14349 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14350 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14351 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14352 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14353 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14354 supported tokens.
14355
14356 Example :
14357 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14358 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14359 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14360 # send large files to the big farm
14361 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14362
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014363env(<name>) : string
14364 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14365 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14366 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14367 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14368 certain way.
14369
14370 Examples :
14371 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14372 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14373
14374 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14375 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014377fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14378 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014379 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14380 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014381 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14382 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014383 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014384 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14385 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014386
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014387fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14388 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14389 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14390 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014392fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14393 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14394 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14395 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14396 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14397 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14398 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14399 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14400 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014401
14402 Example :
14403 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14404 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14405 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14406 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14407 frontend mail
14408 bind :25
14409 mode tcp
14410 maxconn 100
14411 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14412 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14413 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14414 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014415
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014416hostname : string
14417 Returns the system hostname.
14418
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014419int(<integer>) : signed integer
14420 Returns a signed integer.
14421
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014422ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14423 Returns an ipv4.
14424
14425ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14426 Returns an ipv6.
14427
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014428lat_ns_avg : integer
14429 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14430 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14431 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14432 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14433 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14434 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14435 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14436 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14437 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14438 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14439 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14440 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14441 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14442 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14443
14444lat_ns_tot : integer
14445 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14446 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14447 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14448 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14449 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14450 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14451 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14452 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14453 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14454 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14455 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14456 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14457 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14458 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14459 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14460 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14461 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14462 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14463 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14464
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014465meth(<method>) : method
14466 Returns a method.
14467
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014468nbproc : integer
14469 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14470 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14471 and debugging purposes.
14472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014473nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14474 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14475 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14476 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014477 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14478 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14479 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014480
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014481prio_class : integer
14482 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14483 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14484 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14485
14486prio_offset : integer
14487 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14488 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14489 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14490 set-priority-offset".
14491
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014492proc : integer
14493 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14494 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14495 debugging purposes.
14496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014497queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014498 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14499 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14500 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014501 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14502 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14503 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14504 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14505 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14506
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014507rand([<range>]) : integer
14508 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14509 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14510 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14511 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14512 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14513
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020014514uuid([<version>]) : string
14515 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
14516 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
14517 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
14518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014519srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14520 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14521 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14522 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14523 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14524 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014525 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14526 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14527
14528srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14529 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14530 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14531 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14532 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14533 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14534 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14535 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14536
14537 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14538 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014539
14540srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14541 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14542 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14543 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014544 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014545 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14546 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14547 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14548
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014549srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14550 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14551 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14552 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14553 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14554 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14555 fetch methods.
14556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014557srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14558 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14559 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014560 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014561 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14562 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014563 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014564 overloading servers).
14565
14566 Example :
14567 # Redirect to a separate back
14568 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14569 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14570 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14571
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014572stopping : boolean
14573 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14574 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14575 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14576
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014577str(<string>) : string
14578 Returns a string.
14579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014580table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14581 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14582 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14583
14584table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14585 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14586 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14587 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14588
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014589thread : integer
14590 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14591 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14592 and debugging purposes.
14593
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014594var(<var-name>) : undefined
14595 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014596 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14597 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014598 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014599 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14600 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014601 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014602 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14603 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014604 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014605 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014606
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200146077.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014608----------------------------------
14609
14610The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14611closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14612methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14613sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14614TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014615the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14616counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014617"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14618used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14619can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14620Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14621table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14622tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14623currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014624
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014625bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014626 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14627 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14628 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014630be_id : integer
14631 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14632 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14633
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014634be_name : string
14635 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14636 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14637
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014638dst : ip
14639 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14640 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14641 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14642 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014643 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14644 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14645 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14646 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14647 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14648 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014649
14650dst_conn : integer
14651 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14652 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14653 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14654 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14655 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14656 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14657 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14658 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014659
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014660dst_is_local : boolean
14661 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14662 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14663 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14664 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014665 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014666 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14667 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14668 it only once per connection.
14669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014670dst_port : integer
14671 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14672 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14673 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14674 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14675 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14676 an HTTP header.
14677
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014678fc_http_major : integer
14679 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14680 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14681 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14682
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020014683fc_pp_authority : string
14684 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
14685 if any.
14686
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014687fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14688 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14689 header.
14690
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014691fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14692 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14693 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14694 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14695 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14696 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14697 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14698
14699fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14700 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14701 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14702 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14703 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14704 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14705 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14706
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014707fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014708 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14709 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14710 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14711 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14712
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014713fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014714 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14715 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14716 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14717 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14718
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014719fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014720 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14721 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14722 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14723 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14724
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014725fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014726 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14727 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14728 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14729 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14730
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014731fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014732 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14733 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14734 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14735 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14736
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014737fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014738 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14739 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14740 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14741 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14742
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014743fe_defbe : string
14744 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14745 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014747fe_id : integer
14748 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014749 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014750 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14751
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014752fe_name : string
14753 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14754 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14755 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14756
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014757sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014758sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14759sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14760sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014761 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14762 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14763 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14764
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014765sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014766sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14767sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14768sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014769 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14770 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14771 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14772
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014773sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014774sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14775sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14776sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014777 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14778 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014779 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14780 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14781 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014782
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014783 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014784 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14785 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014786 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14787 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14788 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014789 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14790 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14791
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014792sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14793sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14794sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14795sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14796 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14797 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14798 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14799 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14800 when a first ACL was verified.
14801
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014802sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014803sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14804sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14805sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014806 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014807 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14808
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014809sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014810sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14811sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14812sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014813 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14814 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14815 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14816
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014817sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014818sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14819sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14820sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014821 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14822 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14823 See also src_conn_rate.
14824
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014825sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014826sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14827sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14828sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014829 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014830 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014831
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014832sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14833sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14834sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14835sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14836 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14837 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14838
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014839sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14840sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14841sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14842sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14843 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14844 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14845
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014846sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014847sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14848sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14849sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014850 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14851 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14852 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014853 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14854 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14855 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014856
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014857sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14858sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14859sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14860sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14861 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14862 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14863 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14864 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14865 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14866 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14867
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014868sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014869sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14870sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14871sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014872 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014873 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14874 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14875
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014876sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014877sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14878sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14879sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014880 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14881 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14882 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14883 src_http_err_rate.
14884
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014885sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014886sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14887sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14888sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014889 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014890 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14891 src_http_req_cnt.
14892
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014893sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014894sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14895sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14896sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014897 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14898 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14899 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14900 src_http_req_rate.
14901
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014902sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014903sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14904sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14905sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014906 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014907 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14908 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14909 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14910 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014911
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014912 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014913 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14914 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014915 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14916
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014917sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14918sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14919sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14920sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14921 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14922 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14923 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14924 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14925 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14926
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014927sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014928sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14929sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14930sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014931 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14932 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14933 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014934
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014935sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014936sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14937sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14938sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014939 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
14940 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14941 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014942
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014943sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014944sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14945sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14946sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014947 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014948 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
14949 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
14950 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014951 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014952 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
14953
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014954sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014955sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14956sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14957sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014958 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
14959 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14960 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
14961 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
14962 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014963 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014964
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014965sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014966sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14967sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14968sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020014969 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
14970 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
14971 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
14972
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014973sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014974sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14975sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14976sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014977 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14978 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014979 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014980 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
14981 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014982 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
14983 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
14984 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014986so_id : integer
14987 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
14988 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
14989 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014990
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014991src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014992 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014993 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
14994 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
14995 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014996 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
14997 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
14998 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014999 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15000 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15001 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15002 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15003 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15004 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15005 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015006
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015007 Example:
15008 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15009 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015011src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15012 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15013 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15014 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015015 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015017src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15018 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15019 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015020 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015021 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015023src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15024 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15025 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15026 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15027 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15028 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15029 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015030
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015031 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015032 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15033 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15034 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15035 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015036 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015037 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15038 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15039
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015040src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15041 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15042 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15043 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15044 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15045 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15046 was verified.
15047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015048src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015049 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015050 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015051 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015052 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015054src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015055 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015056 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15057 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015058 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015060src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15061 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15062 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15063 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015064 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015066src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015067 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015068 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015069 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015070 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015071
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015072src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15073 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15074 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15075 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15076 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15077
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015078src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15079 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15080 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15081 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15082 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015084src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015085 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015086 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015087 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15088 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015089 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15090 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15091 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015092
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015093src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15094 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15095 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15096 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15097 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15098 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15099 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15100 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015102src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015103 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015104 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015105 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015106 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015107 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015109src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15110 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15111 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15112 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15113 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015114 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015116src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015117 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015118 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15119 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015120 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015122src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15123 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15124 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15125 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015126 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015127 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015129src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15130 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15131 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15132 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015133 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015134 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15135 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015136
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015137 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015138 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015139 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015140 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015141
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015142src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15143 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15144 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15145 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15146 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15147 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15148 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15149
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015150src_is_local : boolean
15151 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15152 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15153 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15154 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015155 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015156 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15157 once per connection.
15158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015159src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015160 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15161 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15162 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15163 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15164 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015165
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015166src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015167 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15168 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15169 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15170 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15171 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015173src_port : integer
15174 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15175 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15176 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15177 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015179src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015180 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015181 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15182 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15183 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015184 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015186src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15187 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15188 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15189 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15190 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015191 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015193src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15194 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15195 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15196 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15197 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15198 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15199 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15200 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15201 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015202
15203 Example :
15204 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15205 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15206 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15207 listen ssh
15208 bind :22
15209 mode tcp
15210 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015211 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015212 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015213 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015215srv_id : integer
15216 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15217 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15218 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015219
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080015220srv_name : string
15221 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
15222 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15223 debugging.
15224
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200152257.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015226----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015228The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15229closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15230when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15231usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015232future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015233
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001523451d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15235 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15236 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15237 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15238 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15239 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15240
15241 Example :
15242 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15243 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15244 # the request.
15245 frontend http-in
15246 bind *:8081
15247 default_backend servers
15248 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15249 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15250
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015251ssl_bc : boolean
15252 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15253 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15254 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15255
15256ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15257 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15258 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15259
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015260ssl_bc_alpn : string
15261 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15262 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015263 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015264 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15265 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15266 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15267 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15268 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15269 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15270
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015271ssl_bc_cipher : string
15272 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15273 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15274
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015275ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15276 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15277 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15278 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15279
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015280ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15281 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15282 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15283 session or a TLS ticket.
15284
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015285ssl_bc_npn : string
15286 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15287 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015288 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015289 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15290 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15291 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15292 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15293 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15294
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015295ssl_bc_protocol : string
15296 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15297 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15298
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015299ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015300 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015301 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15302 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015303
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015304ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15305 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15306 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15307 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15308
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015309ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15310 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15311 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15312 if session was reused or not.
15313
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015314ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15315 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15316 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15317 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15318 BoringSSL.
15319
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015320ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15321 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15322 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015324ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15325 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15326 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15327 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15328 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15329 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015331ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15332 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15333 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15334 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15335 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015336
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015337ssl_c_der : binary
15338 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15339 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15340 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015342ssl_c_err : integer
15343 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15344 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15345 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15346 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15347 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015348
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015349ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015350 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15351 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15352 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15353 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15354 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15355 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15356 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15357 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015358 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15359 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15360 LDAP v3.
15361 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15362 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015364ssl_c_key_alg : string
15365 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15366 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15367 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015369ssl_c_notafter : string
15370 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15371 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15372 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015374ssl_c_notbefore : string
15375 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15376 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15377 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015378
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015379ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015380 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15381 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15382 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15383 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15384 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15385 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15386 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15387 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015388 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15389 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15390 LDAP v3.
15391 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15392 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015394ssl_c_serial : binary
15395 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15396 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15397 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015399ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15400 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15401 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15402 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015403 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15404 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15405
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015406 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015407 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015408
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015409ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15410 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15411 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15412 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015414ssl_c_used : boolean
15415 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15416 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015418ssl_c_verify : integer
15419 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15420 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15421 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15422 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015424ssl_c_version : integer
15425 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15426 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015427
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015428ssl_f_der : binary
15429 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15430 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15431 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15432
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015433ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015434 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15435 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15436 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15437 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015438 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015439 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15440 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15441 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015442 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15443 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15444 LDAP v3.
15445 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15446 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015448ssl_f_key_alg : string
15449 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15450 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15451 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015453ssl_f_notafter : string
15454 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15455 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15456 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015458ssl_f_notbefore : string
15459 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15460 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15461 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015462
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015463ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015464 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15465 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15466 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15467 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15468 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15469 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15470 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15471 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015472 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15473 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15474 LDAP v3.
15475 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15476 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015478ssl_f_serial : binary
15479 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15480 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15481 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015482
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015483ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15484 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15485 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15486 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015488ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15489 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15490 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15491 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015493ssl_f_version : integer
15494 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15495 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15496
15497ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015498 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15499 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15500 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015502 Example :
15503 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15504 listen http-https
15505 bind :80
15506 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15507 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15508
15509ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15510 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15511 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15512
15513ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015514 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015515 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15516 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15517 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15518 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15519 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15520 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15521 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15522 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015524ssl_fc_cipher : string
15525 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15526 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015527
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015528ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15529 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15530 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015531 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015532
15533ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15534 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15535 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015536 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015537
15538ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15539 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15540 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15541 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015542 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015543 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015544
15545ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15546 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15547 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015548 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015549
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015550ssl_fc_client_random : binary
15551 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15552 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15553 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015555ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015556 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15557 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015558 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15559 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15560 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15561 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015562
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015563ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15564 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15565 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15566 wait until the handshake happened.
15567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015568ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15569 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015570 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15571 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015572 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015573 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015574
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015575ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015576 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015577 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15578 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015580ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015581 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015582 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15583 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15584 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15585 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15586 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15587 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15588 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015590ssl_fc_protocol : string
15591 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15592 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015593
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015594ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015595 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015596 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15597 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015598
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015599ssl_fc_server_random : binary
15600 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15601 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15602 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015604ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15605 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15606 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15607 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15608 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015609
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015610ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15611 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15612 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15613 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15614 BoringSSL.
15615
15616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015617ssl_fc_sni : string
15618 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15619 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15620 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15621 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15622 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15623
15624 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15625 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15626 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015627 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015628 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015630 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015631 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15632 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015634ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15635 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15636 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015637
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015638
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200156397.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015640------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015642Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15643sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15644only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15645For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15646be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15647can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15648sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15649for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15650content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015652payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015653 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015654 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15655 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015657payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15658 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015659 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015660 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015661
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015662req.hdrs : string
15663 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15664 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15665 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15666 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15667
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015668req.hdrs_bin : binary
15669 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15670 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15671 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15672 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15673 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15674 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15675
15676 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15677
15678 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15679 str: <int:length><bytes>
15680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015681req.len : integer
15682req_len : integer (deprecated)
15683 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15684 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15685 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15686 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15687 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15688 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15689 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15690 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015692req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15693 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015694 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15695 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15696 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15697 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015699 ACL alternatives :
15700 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015702req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15703 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15704 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15705 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15706 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015708 ACL alternatives :
15709 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015710
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015711 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015713req.proto_http : boolean
15714req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15715 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15716 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15717 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15718 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15719 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15720 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15721 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015723 Example:
15724 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15725 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15726 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015727 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015729req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15730rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15731 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15732 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15733 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15734 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15735 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15736 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15737 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015738
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015739 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15740 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15741 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15742 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15743 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15744 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015746 ACL derivatives :
15747 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015748
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015749 Example :
15750 listen tse-farm
15751 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15752 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15753 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15754 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15755 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15756 persist rdp-cookie
15757 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15758 # This is only useful makes sense if
15759 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15760 stick-table type string size 204800
15761 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15762 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15763 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015765 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15766 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015768req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15769rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15770 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15771 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15772 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15773 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015775 ACL derivatives :
15776 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015777
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015778req.ssl_alpn : string
15779 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
15780 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
15781 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
15782 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
15783 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
15784 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015785 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015786
15787 Examples :
15788 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15789 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15790 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015791 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015792 default_backend bk_default
15793
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015794req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15795 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15796 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015797 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15798 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15799 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15800 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15801 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015803req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15804req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15805 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15806 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15807 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15808 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15809 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15810 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15811 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015813req.ssl_sni : string
15814req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15815 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15816 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15817 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15818 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15819 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15820 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15821 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15822 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15823 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15824 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15825 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15826 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015828 ACL derivatives :
15829 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015831 Examples :
15832 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15833 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15834 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15835 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15836 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015837
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015838req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15839 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15840 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15841 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15842 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15843 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15844 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15845 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15846 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15847 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015849req.ssl_ver : integer
15850req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15851 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15852 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15853 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15854 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15855 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15856 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15857 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015858 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015859 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015861 ACL derivatives :
15862 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015863
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015864res.len : integer
15865 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15866 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15867 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15868 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15869 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15870 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15871 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15872 content inspection.
15873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015874res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15875 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015876 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15877 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15878 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15879 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015881res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15882 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15883 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15884 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15885 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015887 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015888
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015889res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15890rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15891 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15892 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15893 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15894 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15895 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15896 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15897 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015899wait_end : boolean
15900 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15901 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015902 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015903 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15904 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015905 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015906 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15907 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015909 Examples :
15910 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15911 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15912 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015914 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15915 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15916 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15917 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15918 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15919 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15920 tcp-request content reject
15921
15922
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200159237.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015924--------------------------------------
15925
15926It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15927This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15928data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15929its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15930HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15931content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15932to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15933more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15934response are indexed.
15935
15936base : string
15937 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15938 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15939 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15940 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15941 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15942 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15943 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15944 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15945
15946 ACL derivatives :
15947 base : exact string match
15948 base_beg : prefix match
15949 base_dir : subdir match
15950 base_dom : domain match
15951 base_end : suffix match
15952 base_len : length match
15953 base_reg : regex match
15954 base_sub : substring match
15955
15956base32 : integer
15957 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15958 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15959 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015960 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
15961 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
15962 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015963
15964base32+src : binary
15965 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
15966 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
15967 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
15968 per-URL counters.
15969
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015970capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
15971 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
15972 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15973 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
15974
15975capture.req.method : string
15976 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
15977 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
15978 because it's allocated.
15979
15980capture.req.uri : string
15981 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
15982 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
15983 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
15984 allocated.
15985
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015986capture.req.ver : string
15987 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15988 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
15989 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
15990
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015991capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
15992 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
15993 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15994 The first entry is an index of 0.
15995 See also: "capture response header"
15996
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015997capture.res.ver : string
15998 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15999 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16000 persistent flag.
16001
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016002req.body : binary
16003 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16004 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16005 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16006 the first chunk is analyzed.
16007
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016008req.body_param([<name>) : string
16009 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16010 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16011 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16012 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16013 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16014 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16015 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16016 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16017 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16018 given.
16019
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016020req.body_len : integer
16021 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16022 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16023 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16024 "option http-buffer-request".
16025
16026req.body_size : integer
16027 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16028 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16029 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16030 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16031 "option http-buffer-request".
16032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016033req.cook([<name>]) : string
16034cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16035 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16036 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16037 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16038 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16039 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16040 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16041 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16042 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16043
16044 ACL derivatives :
16045 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16046 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16047 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16048 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16049 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16050 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16051 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16052 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016054req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16055cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16056 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16057 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016059req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16060cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16061 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16062 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16063 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16064 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016066cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16067 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16068 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16069 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16070 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016071 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016072 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16073 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16074 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16075 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016077hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16078 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16079 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16080 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16081 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016082 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016084req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16085 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16086 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16087 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16088 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16089 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16090 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16091 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16092 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016094req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16095 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16096 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16097 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16098 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016100req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16101 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16102 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16103 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16104 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16105 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16106 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16107 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16108 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016109 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016110 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016111 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016113 ACL derivatives :
16114 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16115 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16116 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16117 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16118 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16119 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16120 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16121 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16122
16123req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16124hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16125 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16126 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16127 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16128 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16129 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16130 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16131 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16132 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16133 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16134
16135req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16136hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16137 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16138 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16139 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16140 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16141 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016142 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016143 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16144 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16145
16146req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16147hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16148 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16149 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16150 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16151 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16152 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16153 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16154 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16155
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016156
16157
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016158http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16159 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16160 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16161 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16162 basic auth is supported.
16163
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016164http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16165 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16166 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16167 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16168 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016169 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16170 basic auth is supported.
16171
16172 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016173 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16174 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16175 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16176 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016177
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016178http_auth_pass : string
16179 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
16180 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16181 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16182
16183http_auth_type : string
16184 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
16185 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16186 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16187
16188http_auth_user : string
16189 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
16190 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
16191 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016193http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016194 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16195 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016196 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16197 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016199method : integer + string
16200 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16201 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16202 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16203 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16204 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16205 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16206 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016208 ACL derivatives :
16209 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016211 Example :
16212 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16213 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16214 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016216path : string
16217 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16218 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16219 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16220 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16221 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016222 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016223 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016225 ACL derivatives :
16226 path : exact string match
16227 path_beg : prefix match
16228 path_dir : subdir match
16229 path_dom : domain match
16230 path_end : suffix match
16231 path_len : length match
16232 path_reg : regex match
16233 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016234
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016235query : string
16236 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16237 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16238 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16239 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016240 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016241 which stops before the question mark.
16242
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016243req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16244 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16245 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16246 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16247 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016249req.ver : string
16250req_ver : string (deprecated)
16251 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16252 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16253 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016255 ACL derivatives :
16256 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016258res.comp : boolean
16259 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16260 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16261 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016263res.comp_algo : string
16264 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16265 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16266 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016268res.cook([<name>]) : string
16269scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16270 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16271 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16272 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016274 ACL derivatives :
16275 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016277res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16278scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16279 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16280 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16281 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016283res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16284scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16285 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16286 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16287 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016289res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16290 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16291 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16292 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16293 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16294 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16295 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16296 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16297 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16298 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016300res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16301 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16302 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16303 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16304 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16305 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016307res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16308shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16309 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16310 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16311 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16312 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16313 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16314 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16315 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16316 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016318 ACL derivatives :
16319 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16320 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16321 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16322 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16323 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16324 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16325 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16326 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16327
16328res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16329shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16330 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16331 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16332 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16333 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16334 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016336res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16337shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16338 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16339 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16340 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16341 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16342 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16343 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016344
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016345res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16346 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16347 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16348 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16349 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016351res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16352shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16353 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16354 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16355 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16356 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16357 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16358 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016360res.ver : string
16361resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16362 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16363 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016365 ACL derivatives :
16366 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016368set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16369 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16370 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016371 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016372 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016374 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16375 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016377status : integer
16378 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16379 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16380 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016381
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016382unique-id : string
16383 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16384 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16385 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16386 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16387 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16388 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16389
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016390url : string
16391 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16392 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16393 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16394 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16395 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16396 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16397 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016399 ACL derivatives :
16400 url : exact string match
16401 url_beg : prefix match
16402 url_dir : subdir match
16403 url_dom : domain match
16404 url_end : suffix match
16405 url_len : length match
16406 url_reg : regex match
16407 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016408
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016409url_ip : ip
16410 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16411 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16412 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16413 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16414 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16415 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16416 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016418url_port : integer
16419 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16420 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16421 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16422 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016423
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016424urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16425url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016426 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16427 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016428 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16429 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16430 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16431 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016432 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16433 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016434 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16435 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016437 ACL derivatives :
16438 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16439 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16440 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16441 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16442 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16443 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16444 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16445 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016446
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016448 Example :
16449 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16450 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16451 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16452 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016453
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016454urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016455 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16456 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16457 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016458
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016459url32 : integer
16460 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16461 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16462 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16463 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16464 is an unsigned integer.
16465
16466url32+src : binary
16467 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16468 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16469 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16470
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016471
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +0100164727.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
16473---------------------------------------
16474
16475This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
16476used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
16477purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
16478There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
16479or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
16480any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
16481for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
16482
16483internal.htx.data : integer
16484 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
16485 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16486
16487internal.htx.free : integer
16488 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
16489 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16490
16491internal.htx.free_data : integer
16492 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
16493 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16494
16495internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
16496 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
16497 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
16498 chosen depending on the sample direction.
16499
16500internal.htx.nbblks : integer
16501 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
16502 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16503
16504internal.htx.size : integer
16505 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
16506 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16507
16508internal.htx.used : integer
16509 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
16510 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16511 direction.
16512
16513internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
16514 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
16515 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
16516 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
16517 of the special value :
16518 * head : The oldest inserted block
16519 * tail : The newest inserted block
16520 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16521
16522internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
16523 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
16524 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
16525 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
16526 integer or one of the special value :
16527 * head : The oldest inserted block
16528 * tail : The newest inserted block
16529 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16530
16531internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
16532 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
16533 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
16534 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16535 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16536
16537 * head : The oldest inserted block
16538 * tail : The newest inserted block
16539 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16540
16541internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
16542 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
16543 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
16544 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16545 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16546
16547 * head : The oldest inserted block
16548 * tail : The newest inserted block
16549 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16550
16551internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
16552 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
16553 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
16554 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16555 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16556
16557 * head : The oldest inserted block
16558 * tail : The newest inserted block
16559 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16560
16561internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
16562 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
16563 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
16564 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16565 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16566
16567 * head : The oldest inserted block
16568 * tail : The newest inserted block
16569 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16570
16571internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
16572 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
16573 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
16574 it returns false.
16575
16576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200165777.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016578---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016579
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016580Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16581every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016582order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016583
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016584ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16585---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016586FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016587HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016588HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16589HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016590HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16591HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16592HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16593HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16594LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016595METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016596METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016597METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16598METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16599METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16600METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016601METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016602METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016603RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016604REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016605TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016606WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16607---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016608
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016609
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166108. Logging
16611----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016612
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016613One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16614provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16615very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16616provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16617state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016618to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016619headers.
16620
16621In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16622about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16623send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16624
16625 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16626 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16627 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16628 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16629 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016630 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016631 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016632
16633The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16634allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16635as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16636while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16637real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16638delay.
16639
16640
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166418.1. Log levels
16642---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016643
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016644TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016645source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016646HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16647in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16648track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16649syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16650about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016651
16652
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166538.2. Log formats
16654----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016655
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016656HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016657and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16658slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16659options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016660
16661 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16662 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16663 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16664 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16665 extents.
16666
16667 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16668 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16669 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16670 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16671 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16672
16673 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16674 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16675 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16676 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16677 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16678
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016679 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16680 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16681 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16682 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16683
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016684 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16685
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016686Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16687specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16688field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16689servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16690always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16691identifier.
16692
16693Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16694 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16695 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16696 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16697 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16698
16699
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167008.2.1. Default log format
16701-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016702
16703This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16704as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16705format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16706
16707 Example :
16708 listen www
16709 mode http
16710 log global
16711 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16712
16713 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16714 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16715 (www/HTTP)
16716
16717 Field Format Extract from the example above
16718 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16719 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16720 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16721 4 'to' to
16722 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16723 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16724
16725Detailed fields description :
16726 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16727 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16728 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16729 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16730 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16731 and processed the connection.
16732 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16733
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016734In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16735"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16736connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16737
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016738It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16739will eventually disappear.
16740
16741
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167428.2.2. TCP log format
16743---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016744
16745The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16746is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16747information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16748counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16749emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16750environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16751the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16752sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016753specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16754not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16755fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16756marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016757
16758 Example :
16759 frontend fnt
16760 mode tcp
16761 option tcplog
16762 log global
16763 default_backend bck
16764
16765 backend bck
16766 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16767
16768 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16769 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16770 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16771
16772 Field Format Extract from the example above
16773 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16774 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16775 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16776 4 frontend_name fnt
16777 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16778 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16779 7 bytes_read* 212
16780 8 termination_state --
16781 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16782 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16783
16784Detailed fields description :
16785 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016786 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16787 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16788 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016789 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016790 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016791 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016792
16793 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016794 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16795 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16796 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016797
16798 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16799 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16800 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016801 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16802 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16803 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16804 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016805
16806 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16807 and processed the connection.
16808
16809 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16810 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16811 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16812 applications.
16813
16814 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16815 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16816 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16817 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16818 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16819
16820 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16821 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16822 See "Timers" below for more details.
16823
16824 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16825 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16826 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16827 "Timers" below for more details.
16828
16829 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016830 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016831 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16832 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16833 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16834 details.
16835
16836 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16837 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16838 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16839 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16840 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16841
16842 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16843 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16844 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16845 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16846 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16847 for more details.
16848
16849 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016850 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016851 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16852 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16853 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016854 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016855
16856 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16857 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16858 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16859 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16860 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16861 caused by a denial of service attack.
16862
16863 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16864 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16865 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16866 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16867 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16868 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16869 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16870 denial of service attack.
16871
16872 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16873 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16874 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16875 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16876 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16877 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16878 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16879 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16880 be processed than on other servers.
16881
16882 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16883 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16884 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16885 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16886 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16887 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16888 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16889 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16890 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16891 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16892 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16893 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16894 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16895
16896 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16897 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16898 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16899 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16900 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16901 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016902 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016903 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16904
16905 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16906 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16907 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16908 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16909 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16910 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016911 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016912 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16913 occurs.
16914
16915
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169168.2.3. HTTP log format
16917----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016918
16919The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16920is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16921the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16922are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16923emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16924generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16925"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16926which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016927frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16928is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016929
16930Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16931slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16932with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16933
16934 Example :
16935 frontend http-in
16936 mode http
16937 option httplog
16938 log global
16939 default_backend bck
16940
16941 backend static
16942 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16943
16944 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16945 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16946 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016947 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016948
16949 Field Format Extract from the example above
16950 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16951 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016952 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016953 4 frontend_name http-in
16954 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016955 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016956 7 status_code 200
16957 8 bytes_read* 2750
16958 9 captured_request_cookie -
16959 10 captured_response_cookie -
16960 11 termination_state ----
16961 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16962 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16963 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16964 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16965 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016966
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016967Detailed fields description :
16968 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016969 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16970 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16971 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016972 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016973 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016974 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016975
16976 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016977 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16978 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16979 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016980
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016981 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16982 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016983
16984 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16985 and processed the connection.
16986
16987 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16988 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16989 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16990
16991 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16992 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16993 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16994 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16995 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16996 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16997
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016998 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16999 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
17000 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017001 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017002 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
17003 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017004 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
17005 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017006
17007 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17008 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017009 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017010
17011 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17012 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017013 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
17014 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017015
17016 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
17017 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
17018 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
17019 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
17020 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017021 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
17022 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017023
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017024 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
17025 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
17026 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
17027 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
17028 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
17029 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
17030 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017031 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017032
17033 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
17034 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
17035 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
17036
17037 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
17038 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017039 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017040 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
17041 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
17042 overflowing.
17043
17044 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
17045 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
17046 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
17047 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
17048 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
17049 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
17050 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
17051 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17052
17053 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
17054 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
17055 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
17056 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
17057 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
17058 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
17059 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
17060 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17061
17062 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17063 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17064 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
17065 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
17066 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
17067 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
17068 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17069
17070 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017071 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017072 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
17073 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
17074 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017075 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017076 system.
17077
17078 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17079 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17080 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17081 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17082 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17083 caused by a denial of service attack.
17084
17085 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17086 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17087 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17088 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17089 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17090 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17091 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17092 denial of service attack.
17093
17094 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17095 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17096 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17097 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17098 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17099 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17100 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17101 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17102 processed than on other servers.
17103
17104 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17105 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17106 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17107 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17108 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17109 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17110 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17111 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17112 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17113 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17114 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17115 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17116 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17117
17118 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17119 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17120 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17121 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17122 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17123 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017124 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017125 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17126
17127 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17128 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17129 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17130 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17131 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17132 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017133 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017134 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17135 occurs.
17136
17137 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17138 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17139 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17140 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17141 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17142 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17143 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17144 cookies" below for more details.
17145
17146 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17147 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17148 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17149 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17150 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17151 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17152 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17153 and cookies" below for more details.
17154
17155 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17156 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17157 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17158 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17159 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17160 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17161 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17162 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17163
17164
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200171658.2.4. Custom log format
17166------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017167
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017168The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017169mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017170
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017171HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017172Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17173separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17174prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17175
17176Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17177variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017178("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017179
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017180If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017181as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017182less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17183the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17184
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017185Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017186In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017187in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017188
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017189Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17190'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17191https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17192such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17193
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017194Flags are :
17195 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017196 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017197 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17198 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017199
17200 Example:
17201
17202 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17203 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17204
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017205 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17206
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017207At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17208
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017209 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17210 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017211
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017212the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017213
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017214 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17215 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17216 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017217
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017218and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17219
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017220 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17221 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017222
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017223Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17224
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017225 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017226 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017227 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17228 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17229 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017230 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17231 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17232 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017233 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017234 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17235 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017236 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017237 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17238 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017239 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017240 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017241 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017242 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017243 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017244 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017245 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017246 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17247 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17248 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17249 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17250 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017251 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017252 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17253 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017254 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017255 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17256 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017257 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17258 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17259 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017260 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017261 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17262 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017263 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017264 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17265 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17266 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017267 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017268 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017269 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17270 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17271 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17272 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017273 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017274 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017275 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017276 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017277 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017278 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017279 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17280 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17281 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017282 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017283 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17284 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017285 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017286 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17287 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017288 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017289 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017290 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017291 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017292
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017293 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017294
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017295
172968.2.5. Error log format
17297-----------------------
17298
17299When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17300protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17301By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17302"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017303will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017304logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17305
17306The format looks like this :
17307
17308 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17309 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17310 Connection error during SSL handshake
17311
17312 Field Format Extract from the example above
17313 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17314 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17315 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17316 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17317 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17318
17319These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17320failures.
17321
17322
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173238.3. Advanced logging options
17324-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017325
17326Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17327just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17328options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17329for more information about their usage.
17330
17331
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173328.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17333------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017334
17335It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17336haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17337commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17338monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17339ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17340
17341 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17342 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17343 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17344 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17345
17346 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17347 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17348 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017349 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017350 such as other load-balancers.
17351
17352 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17353 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17354 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17355
17356
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173578.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17358----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017359
17360The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17361what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17362or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017363"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017364just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17365log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17366after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17367is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17368with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17369with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17370
17371
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173728.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17373------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017374
17375Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17376for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17377"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17378retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17379raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17380a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17381file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17382you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17383"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17384
17385
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173868.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17387--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017388
17389Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17390multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17391them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17392"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17393logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17394error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17395and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17396too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17397useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17398alternative.
17399
17400
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174018.4. Timing events
17402------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017403
17404Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17405reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17406the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17407frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017408mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17409addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17410
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017411Timings events in HTTP mode:
17412
17413 first request 2nd request
17414 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17415 t tr t tr ...
17416 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17417 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17418 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17419 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17420 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17421
17422Timings events in TCP mode:
17423
17424 TCP session
17425 |<----------------->|
17426 t t
17427 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17428 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17429 |<------ Tt ------->|
17430
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017431 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017432 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017433 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17434 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17435 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017436 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017437 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17438 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17439 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17440 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017441
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017442 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17443 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17444 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017445 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17446 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17447 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17448 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17449 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17450 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017451
17452 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17453 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17454 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17455 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17456 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17457 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17458 request typed by hand during a test.
17459
17460 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17461 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017462 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017463 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17464 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17465 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17466 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017467
17468 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17469 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17470 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17471 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17472 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17473
17474 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17475 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17476 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17477 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17478 connection never established.
17479
17480 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17481 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17482 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17483 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17484 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17485 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17486 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17487 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17488 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17489 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17490 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17491
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017492 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17493 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17494 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17495 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17496 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17497 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17498
17499 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17500
17501 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17502 "Ta" can never be negative.
17503
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017504 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17505 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017506 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17507 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017508 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017509
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017510 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017511
17512 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017513 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17514 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017515
17516These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17517protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17518that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017519due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17520"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17521that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017522
17523Most common cases :
17524
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017525 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17526 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17527 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17528 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17529 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17530 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17531 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17532 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17533 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17534 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17535 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017536 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017537
17538 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17539 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17540 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17541 of ms on remote networks.
17542
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017543 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17544 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17545 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017546
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017547 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17548 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17549 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17550 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17551 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17552 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17553 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17554 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17555 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017556
17557Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17558
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017559 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017560 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017561 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017562
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017563 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017564 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17565 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17566
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017567 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017568 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17569 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17570 flags.
17571
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017572 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17573 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017574 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17575 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17576 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17577 the client connection was maintained open.
17578
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017579 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017580 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017581 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017582 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17583
17584
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175858.5. Session state at disconnection
17586-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017587
17588TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17589"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
175902-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17591each of which has a special meaning :
17592
17593 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17594 session to terminate :
17595
17596 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17597
17598 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17599 server explicitly refused it.
17600
17601 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17602 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17603 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17604 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017605 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017606
17607 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17608 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017609
17610 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17611 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17612 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17613 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17614 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17615
17616 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17617 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17618 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17619 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17620 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17621
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017622 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17623 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17624
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017625 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17626 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17627 backup connections when going up.
17628
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017629 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17630
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017631 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17632 send or receive data.
17633
17634 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17635 send or receive data.
17636
17637 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17638 with nothing left in the buffers.
17639
17640 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17641
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017642 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017643 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17644
17645 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17646 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17647 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17648 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17649 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17650
17651 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17652 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17653
17654 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17655 server (HTTP only).
17656
17657 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17658
17659 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17660 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17661 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17662
17663 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17664 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17665 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17666
17667 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17668
17669 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17670 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17671
17672 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17673 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17674 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17675
17676 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17677 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017678 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17679 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017680
17681 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17682 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17683 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17684 another server.
17685
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017686 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017687 server.
17688
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017689 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17690 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17691 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17692 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17693
17694 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17695 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17696 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17697 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17698
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017699 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17700 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17701 "use-server" rule).
17702
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017703 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17704
17705 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17706 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17707
17708 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17709
17710 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17711 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17712 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17713
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017714 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17715 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017716 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017717 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17718 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17719
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017720 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17721
17722 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17723 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17724
17725 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17726
17727 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17728
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017729The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17730was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017731helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17732starvation, attacks, etc...
17733
17734The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17735alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17736easier finding and understanding.
17737
17738 Flags Reason
17739
17740 -- Normal termination.
17741
17742 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17743 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17744 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17745 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17746
17747 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17748 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17749 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17750 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17751 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17752 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017753
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017754 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17755 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017756 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017757
17758 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17759 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17760 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17761
17762 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17763 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17764 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17765 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17766 the server takes too long to respond.
17767
17768 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17769 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17770 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17771 long a time to respond.
17772
17773 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17774 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17775 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17776 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017777 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17778 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017779
17780 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17781 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17782 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17783 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17784 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017785 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017786 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17787 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17788 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17789 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17790 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17791 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17792 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17793 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017794 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017795 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17796 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17797 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017798
17799 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17800 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017801 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17802 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17803 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17804 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017805
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017806 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17807 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17808
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017809 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017810 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17811 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017812 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017813 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17814 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17815
17816 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17817 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17818 503 or 504 here.
17819
17820 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17821 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17822 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17823 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17824 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17825
17826 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17827 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017828 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017829 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17830 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17831
17832 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17833 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17834 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17835 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17836 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17837 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17838 between haproxy and the server.
17839
17840 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17841 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17842 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17843 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17844 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17845 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17846 solution is to fix the application.
17847
17848 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17849 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17850 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17851 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17852 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17853 external attacks.
17854
17855 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17856 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017857 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017858 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17859 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17860
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017861 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17862 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17863 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017864 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017865 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017866
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017867 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17868 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17869 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17870 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017871 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17872 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17873 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17874 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17875 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017876
17877 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17878 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17879 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17880 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17881
17882 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17883 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17884 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17885 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17886
17887 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17888 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17889 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17890 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17891
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017892The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17893persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17894important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17895re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17896
17897 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17898
17899 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17900 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17901 set on a GET request.
17902
17903 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17904 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017905 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017906 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17907
17908 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17909 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17910 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17911
17912 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17913 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17914 already got a cookie.
17915
17916 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17917 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17918 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17919 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17920 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17921
17922 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17923 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17924 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17925
17926 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17927 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17928 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17929
17930 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17931 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17932
17933 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17934 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17935 then advertised in the response.
17936
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017937
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179388.6. Non-printable characters
17939-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017940
17941In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17942consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17943converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17944prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17945being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17946escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17947is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17948'}' when logging headers.
17949
17950Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17951issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17952containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17953
17954Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17955the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17956performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17957
17958
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179598.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17960---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017961
17962Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17963achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017964section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017965cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17966the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17967the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017968locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017969not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17970user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17971a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17972wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17973
17974 Examples :
17975 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17976 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17977
17978 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17979 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17980
17981
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179828.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17983---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017984
17985Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17986proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17987the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17988server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17989
17990Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17991response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017992section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017993
17994It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017995time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17996appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017997are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17998and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17999follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
18000request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
18001in the logs.
18002
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018003As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
18004frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
18005an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
18006
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018007 Example :
18008 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
18009 listen proxy-out
18010 mode http
18011 option httplog
18012 option logasap
18013 log global
18014 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
18015
18016 # log the name of the virtual server
18017 capture request header Host len 20
18018
18019 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
18020 capture request header Content-Length len 10
18021
18022 # log the beginning of the referrer
18023 capture request header Referer len 20
18024
18025 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
18026 capture response header Server len 20
18027
18028 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
18029 capture response header Content-Length len 10
18030
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018031 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018032 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
18033
18034 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
18035 capture response header Via len 20
18036
18037 # log the URL location during a redirection
18038 capture response header Location len 20
18039
18040 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
18041 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
18042 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18043 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
18044 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
18045
18046 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18047 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18048 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18049 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018050 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018051
18052 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18053 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18054 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18055 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
18056 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018057 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018058
18059
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180608.9. Examples of logs
18061---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018062
18063These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
18064them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
18065reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
18066
18067 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
18068 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18069 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18070
18071 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
18072 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
18073
18074 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
18075 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
18076 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18077
18078 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
18079 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
18080
18081 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18082 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18083 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18084
18085 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018086 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018087 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18088 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18089
18090 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18091 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18092 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18093
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020018094 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
18095 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
18096 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
18097 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
18098 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
18099 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018100
18101 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018102 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018103
18104 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18105 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18106 Nothing was sent to any server.
18107
18108 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18109 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18110
18111 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18112 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018113 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018114 send a 408 return code to the client.
18115
18116 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18117 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18118
18119 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18120 5 seconds ("c----").
18121
18122 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18123 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018124 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018125
18126 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018127 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018128 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18129 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18130 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18131 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18132 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018133
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018134
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200181359. Supported filters
18136--------------------
18137
18138Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18139accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18140unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18141
18142See also : "filter"
18143
181449.1. Trace
18145----------
18146
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018147filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018148
18149 Arguments:
18150 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18151 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18152
18153 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18154 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18155 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18156 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18157
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018158 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018159 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18160 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18161 amount of the parsed data.
18162
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018163 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018164
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018165This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18166callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18167information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18168filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18169
18170Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18171tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18172a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18173
18174
181759.2. HTTP compression
18176---------------------
18177
18178filter compression
18179
18180The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18181keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018182when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
18183fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
18184done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
18185explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
18186filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
18187listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18188order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018189
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018190See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
18191 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018192
18193
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200181949.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18195--------------------------------------------
18196
18197filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18198
18199 Arguments :
18200
18201 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18202 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18203 parsed.
18204
18205 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18206 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18207 part must be placed in its own scope.
18208
18209The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18210external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018211streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018212exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18213also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18214
18215SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18216the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18217
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018218For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018219"doc/SPOE.txt".
18220
18221Important note:
18222 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18223 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18224
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100182259.4. Cache
18226----------
18227
18228filter cache <name>
18229
18230 Arguments :
18231
18232 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18233
18234The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18235"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018236cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018237other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
18238case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
18239is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18240filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018241listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18242order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018243
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018244See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
18245 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
18246
18247
182489.5. Fcgi-app
18249-------------
18250
18251filter fcg-app <name>
18252
18253 Arguments :
18254
18255 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
18256
18257The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
18258request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
18259reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
18260used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
18261implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
18262used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
18263fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
18264used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18265order.
18266
18267See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
18268 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
18269
18270
1827110. FastCGI applications
18272-------------------------
18273
18274HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
18275feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
18276the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
18277FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
18278servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
18279FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
18280backend.
18281
18282HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
18283application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
18284connection.
18285
1828610.1. Setup
18287-----------
18288
1828910.1.1. Fcgi-app section
18290--------------------------
18291
18292fcgi-app <name>
18293 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
18294 document root must be defined.
18295
18296acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
18297 Declare or complete an access list.
18298
18299 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
18300 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
18301 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
18302 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
18303 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
18304
18305docroot <path>
18306 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
18307 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
18308 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
18309
18310index <script-name>
18311 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
18312 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
18313 is an optional setting.
18314
18315 Example :
18316 index index.php
18317
18318log-stderr global
18319log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
18320 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
18321 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
18322
18323 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
18324 default STDERR messages are ignored.
18325
18326pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18327 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
18328 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
18329 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18330
18331 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
18332 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
18333 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
18334 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
18335
18336 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
18337 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
18338
18339path-info <regex>
18340 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info
18341 from the URI. Thus, <regex> should have two captures: the first one to
18342 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. It is an
18343 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
18344 URI. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not filled.
18345
18346 Example :
18347 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
18348
18349option get-values
18350no option get-values
18351 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
18352
18353 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
18354 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
18355
18356 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
18357 application will accept.
18358
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020018359 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
18360 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018361
18362 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
18363 the connexion immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
18364 option is disabled.
18365
18366 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
18367 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
18368 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
18369 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
18370 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
18371 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
18372
18373option keep-conn
18374no option keep-conn
18375 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
18376 sending a response.
18377
18378 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
18379 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
18380
18381option max-reqs <reqs>
18382 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
18383 accept.
18384
18385 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
18386 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
18387 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
18388 to 1.
18389
18390option mpxs-conns
18391no option mpxs-conns
18392 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
18393
18394 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
18395 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
18396
18397set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18398 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
18399 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
18400 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
18401 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18402
18403 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
18404 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
18405 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
18406
18407 Example :
18408 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
18409 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
18410
18411 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
18412
18413
1841410.1.2. Proxy section
18415---------------------
18416
18417use-fcgi-app <name>
18418 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
18419
18420 Arguments :
18421 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
18422
18423 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
18424 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
18425 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
18426 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
18427 application may be defined at a time per backend.
18428
18429 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
18430 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
18431 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
18432 application are evaluated.
18433
18434
1843510.1.3. Example
18436---------------
18437
18438 frontend front-http
18439 mode http
18440 bind *:80
18441 bind *:
18442
18443 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
18444 default_backend back-static
18445
18446 backend back-static
18447 mode http
18448 server www A.B.C.D:80
18449
18450 backend back-dynamic
18451 mode http
18452 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
18453 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
18454
18455 fcgi-app php-fpm
18456 log-stderr global
18457 option keep-conn
18458
18459 docroot /var/www/my-app
18460 index index.php
18461 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
18462
18463
1846410.2. Default parameters
18465------------------------
18466
18467A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
18468the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
18469scipt. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
18470applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
18471
18472 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18473 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
18474 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
18475 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
18476 | | |
18477 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18478 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
18479 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
18480 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
18481 | | application. |
18482 | | |
18483 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18484 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
18485 | | the request. It may not be set. |
18486 | | |
18487 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18488 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
18489 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
18490 | | the application's configuration. |
18491 | | |
18492 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18493 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
18494 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
18495 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
18496 | | |
18497 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18498 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
18499 | | following the part that identifies the script |
18500 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
18501 | | be defined. |
18502 | | |
18503 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18504 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
18505 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
18506 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
18507 | | is not set too. |
18508 | | |
18509 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18510 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
18511 | | set. |
18512 | | |
18513 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18514 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
18515 | | the request. |
18516 | | |
18517 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18518 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
18519 | | client as part of user authentication. |
18520 | | |
18521 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18522 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
18523 | | script to process the request. |
18524 | | |
18525 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18526 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
18527 | | |
18528 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18529 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
18530 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
18531 | | |
18532 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18533 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
18534 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
18535 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
18536 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
18537 | | |
18538 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18539 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
18540 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
18541 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
18542 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
18543 | | side. |
18544 | | |
18545 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18546 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
18547 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
18548 | | connected to. |
18549 | | |
18550 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18551 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
18552 | | |
18553 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18554 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
18555 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
18556 | | |
18557 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18558
18559
1856010.3. Limitations
18561------------------
18562
18563The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
18564way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
18565during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
18566establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
18567application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
18568or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
18569message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
18570these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
18571and HTTP servers under the same backend.
18572
18573Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
18574request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
18575requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
18576
18577About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
18578into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
18579fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
18580"http-request" ones.
18581
18582Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
18583FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
18584processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
18585must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
18586here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018587
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018588/*
18589 * Local variables:
18590 * fill-column: 79
18591 * End:
18592 */